]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
Update for MH-E release 7.95.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.4 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 ---
117 ** The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el uses a different terminfo name.
118 The Emacs terminal emulation in term.el now uses "eterm-color" as its
119 terminfo name, since term.el now supports color.
120
121 ---
122 ** Emacs Lisp source files are compressed by default if `gzip' is available.
123
124 \f
125 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
126
127 +++
128 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
129 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
130 the fancy startup screen.
131
132 +++
133 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
134 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
135 the blinking cursor.
136
137 +++
138 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
139 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
140
141 +++
142 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
143 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
144 can start with this line:
145
146 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
147
148 +++
149 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
150 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
151 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
152
153 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
154
155 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
156 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
157
158 +++
159 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
160 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
161
162 ---
163 ** If the environment variable DISPLAY specifies an unreachable X display,
164 Emacs will now startup as if invoked with the --no-window-system option.
165
166 +++
167 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
168 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
169 an interactively callable function.
170
171 +++
172 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
173 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
174 affects the initial frame.
175
176 +++
177 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
178 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
179 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
180 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
181 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
182
183 +++
184 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
185 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
186 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
187 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
188 `inhibit-splash-screen').
189
190 +++
191 ** The default is now to use a bitmap as the icon, so the command-line options
192 --icon-type, -i has been replaced with options --no-bitmap-icon, -nbi to turn
193 the bitmap icon off.
194
195 +++
196 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
197 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
198 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
199
200 +++
201 ** Init file changes
202 If the init file ~/.emacs does not exist, Emacs will try
203 ~/.emacs.d/init.el or ~/.emacs.d/init.elc. You can also put the shell
204 init file .emacs_SHELL under ~/.emacs.d.
205
206 +++
207 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
208 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
209 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
210 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
211 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
212 \f
213 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
214
215 +++
216 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
217 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
218 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
219 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
220
221 +++
222 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
223 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
224
225 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
226 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
227
228 +++
229 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
230 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
231 the operating system or your X server.
232
233 +++
234 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
235
236 +++
237 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
238 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
239 you about it.
240
241 +++
242 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
243 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
244
245 +++
246 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
247 previous mark if you set `set-mark-command-repeat-pop' to t. I.e. C-u
248 C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC
249 to set the mark immediately after a jump.
250
251 +++
252 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
253 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
254
255 +++
256 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
257
258 See below under "incremental search changes".
259
260 ---
261 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
262
263 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
264 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
265 directory with Dired.
266
267 You can get the old behavior by typing C-x C-f M-n RET, which fetches
268 the actual file name into the minibuffer.
269
270 +++
271 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
272 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
273 it remains unchanged.
274
275 +++
276 ** When Emacs prompts for file names, SPC no longer completes the file name.
277 This is so filenames with embedded spaces could be input without the
278 need to quote the space with a C-q. The underlying changes in the
279 keymaps that are active in the minibuffer are described below under
280 "New keymaps for typing file names".
281
282 +++
283 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
284 M-o M-o requests refontification.
285
286 +++
287 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
288
289 See below for more details.
290
291 +++
292 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
293 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
294 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
295 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
296 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
297 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
298 \f
299 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
300
301 +++
302 ** !MEM FULL! at the start of the mode line indicates that Emacs
303 cannot get any more memory for Lisp data. This often means it could
304 crash soon if you do things that use more memory. On most systems,
305 killing buffers will get out of this state. If killing buffers does
306 not make !MEM FULL! disappear, you should save your work and start
307 a new Emacs.
308
309 +++
310 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
311 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
312
313 +++
314 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left
315 (previous-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and
316 C-x right can be used as well. The functions keep a different buffer
317 cycle for each frame, using the frame-local buffer list.
318
319 +++
320 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
321
322 +++
323 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
324 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
325
326 ---
327 ** C-x 5 C-o displays a specified buffer in another frame
328 but does not switch to that frame. It's the multi-frame
329 analogue of C-x 4 C-o.
330
331 ---
332 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
333 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
334
335 +++
336 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
337 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
338
339 +++
340 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
341 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
342 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
343 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
344
345 +++
346 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
347 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
348 in Indented-Text mode.
349
350 +++
351 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
352
353 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
354 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
355 in the value, use `$$'.
356
357 +++
358 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
359 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
360 `same-window'.
361
362 +++
363 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
364 from the locale.
365
366 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
367 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
368 only faces matching this regexp.
369
370 ** Mark command changes:
371
372 +++
373 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
374 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
375 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
376
377 +++
378 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
379
380 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
381 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
382 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
383 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
384 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
385 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
386 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
387 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
388 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
389
390 +++
391 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
392
393 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
394 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
395 paragraphs.
396
397 +++
398 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
399 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
400 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
401 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
402 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
403 command only.
404
405 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
406 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
407 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
408 mark or the region.
409
410 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
411 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
412 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
413 C-g.
414
415 +++
416 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
417 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
418 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
419
420 ** Help command changes:
421
422 +++
423 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
424
425 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
426
427 C-h d runs apropos-documentation.
428
429 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
430 that do not change:
431
432 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
433 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
434
435 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
436 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
437
438 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
439 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
440 run by the key sequence.
441 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
442 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
443 that command.
444
445 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
446 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
447 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
448 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
449 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
450 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
451 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
452 new-kill-line is on C-k
453
454 ---
455 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
456 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
457 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
458 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
459
460 +++
461 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
462 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
463
464 +++
465 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
466 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
467 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
468 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
469 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
470 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
471 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node'). In
472 addition, it now makes hyperlinks to URLs as well if the URL is
473 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `URL'.
474
475 +++
476 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
477 description various information about a character, including its
478 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
479 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
480 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
481
482 +++
483 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
484 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
485
486 +++
487 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
488 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
489 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
490 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
491 keyboard oriented alternative.
492
493 +++
494 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
495 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
496 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
497 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
498 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
499
500 +++
501 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
502 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
503 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
504 available.
505
506 +++
507 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
508 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
509 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
510 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
511 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
512 matching item.
513
514 ** Incremental Search changes:
515
516 +++
517 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
518 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
519 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
520 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
521 for details.
522
523 +++
524 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
525 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
526 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
527 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
528
529 +++
530 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
531 at the end of a line.
532
533 +++
534 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
535 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
536 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
537
538 +++
539 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
540 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
541 search string used as the string to replace.
542
543 +++
544 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
545 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
546 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
547
548 ** Replace command changes:
549
550 ---
551 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
552 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
553 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
554
555 +++
556 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
557 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
558 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
559 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
560 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
561 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
562 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
563 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
564 can be edited for each replacement.
565
566 +++
567 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
568 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
569
570 ---
571 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
572 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
573
574 ** File operation changes:
575
576 +++
577 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
578 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
579 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
580 is only rarely needed.
581
582 +++
583 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
584 suffix from every line before processing all the lines.
585
586 +++
587 *** If the local variables list contains any variable-value pairs that
588 are not known to be safe, Emacs shows a prompt asking whether to apply
589 the local variables list as a whole. In earlier versions, a prompt
590 was only issued for variables explicitly marked as risky (for the
591 definition of risky variables, see `risky-local-variable-p').
592
593 At the prompt, the user can choose to save the contents of this local
594 variables list to `safe-local-variable-values'. This new customizable
595 option is a list of variable-value pairs that are known to be safe.
596 Variables can also be marked as safe with the existing
597 `safe-local-variable' property (see `safe-local-variable-p').
598 However, risky variables will not be added to
599 `safe-local-variable-values' in this way.
600
601 +++
602 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
603 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
604
605 +++
606 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
607 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
608
609 +++
610 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
611
612 ---
613 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
614
615 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
616 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
617 directory with Dired.
618
619 +++
620 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
621 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
622 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
623 file.)
624
625 +++
626 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
627 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
628
629 +++
630 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
631 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
632 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
633 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
634 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
635 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
636
637 ---
638 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
639 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
640 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
641
642 ---
643 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
644 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
645 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
646
647 +++
648 *** The new option `write-region-inhibit-fsync' disables calls to fsync
649 in `write-region'. This can be useful on laptops to avoid spinning up
650 the hard drive upon each file save. Enabling this variable may result
651 in data loss, use with care.
652
653 +++
654 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
655 Emacs asks for confirmation.
656
657 +++
658 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
659
660 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
661 when visiting the file.
662
663 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
664 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
665 when saving the file.
666
667 +++
668 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
669 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
670 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
671 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
672 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
673 modes do.
674
675 ** Minibuffer changes:
676
677 +++
678 *** The new file-name-shadow-mode is turned ON by default, so that when
679 entering a file name, any prefix which Emacs will ignore is dimmed.
680
681 +++
682 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
683 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
684 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
685 prompt string.
686
687 ---
688 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
689
690 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
691 have in common and where they begin to differ.
692
693 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
694 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
695 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
696 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
697 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
698 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
699 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
700 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
701
702 Above fontification is always done when listing completions is
703 triggered at minibuffer. If you want to fontify completions whose
704 listing is triggered at the other normal buffer, you have to pass
705 the common prefix of completions to `display-completion-list' as
706 its second argument.
707
708 +++
709 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
710 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
711 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
712 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
713 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
714 candidate is a directory.
715
716 +++
717 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
718 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
719 it remains unchanged.
720
721 +++
722 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
723 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
724 elements are deleted.
725
726 ** Redisplay changes:
727
728 +++
729 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
730 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
731 appears between the position information and the major mode.
732
733 +++
734 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
735
736 +++
737 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
738 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
739 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
740
741 +++
742 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
743 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
744 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
745 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
746
747 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
748 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
749 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
750 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
751 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
752 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
753
754 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
755 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
756
757 ---
758 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller than
759 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
760 vscroll property.
761
762 +++
763 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
764 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
765 the mode line of the currently selected window.
766
767 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
768 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
769
770 +++
771 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
772 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
773 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
774 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
775 set-fringe-style.
776
777 +++
778 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
779 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
780 the window can be scrolled.
781
782 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
783 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
784 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
785
786 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
787 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
788
789 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
790 position of each bitmap individually.
791
792 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
793 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
794 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
795 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
796
797 +++
798 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
799 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
800 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
801 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
802 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
803
804 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
805 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
806
807 +++
808 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
809 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
810 outside those margins.
811
812 +++
813 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
814 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
815
816 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
817 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
818 or when the frame is resized.
819
820 ** Cursor display changes:
821
822 +++
823 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
824 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
825
826 +++
827 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
828
829 +++
830 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
831 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
832 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
833 cursor does.
834
835 +++
836 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
837 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
838 appears in.
839
840 +++
841 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
842 of the recognized cursor types.
843
844 +++
845 *** On text terminals, the variable `visible-cursor' controls whether Emacs
846 uses the "very visible" cursor (the default) or the normal cursor.
847
848 ** New faces:
849
850 +++
851 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
852 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
853 areas.
854
855 *** `mode-line-buffer-id' is the standard face for buffer identification
856 parts of the mode line.
857
858 +++
859 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
860 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
861 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
862 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
863 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
864 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
865
866 +++
867 *** `vertical-border' face is used for the vertical divider between windows.
868
869 ** Font-Lock changes:
870
871 +++
872 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
873 M-o M-o requests refontification.
874
875 +++
876 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
877 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
878 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
879
880 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
881 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
882 `Info-mode-hook'.
883
884 +++
885 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
886 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
887 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
888 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
889 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
890
891 +++
892 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
893
894 +++
895 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
896
897 +++
898 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
899 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
900 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
901 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
902
903 ---
904 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
905 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
906 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
907 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
908 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
909
910 ---
911 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
912
913 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
914 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
915 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
916 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
917
918 ---
919 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
920
921 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
922 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
923 refontification takes place.
924
925 ** Menu support:
926
927 ---
928 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
929 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
930 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
931 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
932 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
933 current date and time, current line and column number in the mode-line.
934
935 ---
936 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
937
938 ---
939 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
940
941 ---
942 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
943 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
944 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
945
946 +++
947 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
948 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
949
950 ---
951 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
952 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
953
954 +++
955 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
956 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
957 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
958
959 ---
960 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
961 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
962
963 +++
964 *** For the Gtk+ version, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
965 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
966 the new dialog.
967
968 ** Mouse changes:
969
970 +++
971 *** If you set the new variable `mouse-autoselect-window' to a non-nil
972 value, windows are automatically selected as you move the mouse from
973 one Emacs window to another, even within a frame. A minibuffer window
974 can be selected only when it is active.
975
976 +++
977 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
978 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
979 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
980 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
981 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
982 to give it focus.
983
984 +++
985 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
986
987 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
988 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
989 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
990 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
991 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
992 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
993
994 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
995 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
996 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
997 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
998 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
999 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
1000 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
1001 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
1002 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
1003
1004 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
1005 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
1006 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
1007 you release it).
1008
1009 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
1010 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
1011
1012 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
1013 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
1014
1015 +++
1016 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1017 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1018 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1019 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1020 also disable mouse highlighting.
1021
1022 +++
1023 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1024 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1025 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1026
1027 ---
1028 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1029 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1030
1031 ---
1032 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1033
1034 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1035 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1036 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1037 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1038
1039 +++
1040 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1041
1042 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1043
1044 ---
1045 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1046 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1047 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1048 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1049 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1050
1051 +++
1052 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1053 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1054 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1055 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1056 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1057 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1058 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1059 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1060
1061 +++
1062 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1063 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1064
1065 +++
1066 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1067 coding system.
1068
1069 +++
1070 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1071 of a file.
1072
1073 ---
1074 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1075 unicode.
1076
1077 +++
1078 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1079 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1080 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1081 command.
1082
1083 +++
1084 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1085 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1086
1087 +++
1088 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1089 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1090 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1091 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1092 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1093 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1094 mule-unicode-... ones.
1095
1096 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1097 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1098 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1099 possible.
1100
1101 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1102 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1103 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1104 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1105 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1106
1107 ---
1108 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1109 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1110 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1111 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1112
1113 ---
1114 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1115 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1116 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1117 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1118 automatically according to the locale.)
1119
1120 ---
1121 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1122 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1123 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1124 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1125 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1126 tamil-inscript.
1127
1128 ---
1129 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1130 characters.
1131
1132 ---
1133 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1134 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1135 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1136 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1137 M-f (forward-word)
1138 M-b (backward-word)
1139 M-d (kill-word)
1140 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1141 M-t (transpose-words)
1142 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1143
1144 ---
1145 *** Indian support has been updated.
1146 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1147 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1148 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1149 supported.
1150
1151 ---
1152 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1153
1154 ---
1155 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1156 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1157 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1158 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1159 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1160 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1161 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1162 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1163 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1164 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1165 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1166 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1167
1168 ---
1169 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1170 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1171 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1172
1173 ---
1174 *** Many new coding systems are available in the `code-pages' library.
1175 These include complete versions of most of those in codepage.el, based
1176 on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now obsolete and is used
1177 only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. All coding systems defined in
1178 `code-pages' are auto-loaded.
1179
1180 ---
1181 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1182 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1183
1184 ---
1185 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1186 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1187 fontset appropriately.
1188
1189 ** Customize changes:
1190
1191 +++
1192 *** Custom themes are collections of customize options. Create a
1193 custom theme with M-x customize-create-theme. Use M-x load-theme to
1194 load and enable a theme, and M-x disable-theme to disable it. Use M-x
1195 enable-theme to enable a disabled theme.
1196
1197 +++
1198 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1199 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1200 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1201 faces.
1202
1203 ---
1204 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1205 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1206 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1207 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1208 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1209 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1210 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1211
1212 +++
1213 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1214 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1215 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1216 under the "[State]" button.
1217
1218 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1219
1220 +++
1221 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1222 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to T in Buffer Menu
1223 mode.
1224
1225 +++
1226 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1227 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1228 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1229
1230 ---
1231 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1232 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1233 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1234
1235 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1236 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1237 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1238 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1239 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1240
1241 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1242 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1243 t, and the status is shown.
1244
1245 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1246 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1247
1248 ** Dired mode:
1249
1250 ---
1251 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1252 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1253 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1254
1255 +++
1256 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1257 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1258
1259 +++
1260 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1261 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1262
1263 +++
1264 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1265 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1266 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1267 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1268 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1269 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1270
1271 +++
1272 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1273 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1274
1275 +++
1276 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1277
1278 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1279 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1280 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1281 instead.
1282
1283 +++
1284 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1285 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1286 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1287 directory listing into a buffer.
1288
1289 ** Comint changes:
1290
1291 ---
1292 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1293 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1294 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1295 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1296 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1297
1298 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1299 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1300
1301 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1302 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1303 lines, including any prompts.
1304
1305 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1306 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1307 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1308 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1309 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1310 `kill-region' if read-only properties are involved: it copies the text
1311 to the kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1312
1313 +++
1314 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1315 modes (shell-mode, etc.) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1316 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1317 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1318
1319 +++
1320 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1321 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1322 but declared obsolete.
1323
1324 ** M-x Compile changes:
1325
1326 ---
1327 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1328
1329 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1330 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1331 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1332 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1333
1334 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1335 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1336 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1337
1338 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1339 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1340 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1341 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1342 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1343
1344 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1345
1346 +++
1347 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1348 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1349 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1350 subprocesses inherit.
1351
1352 +++
1353 *** New user option `compilation-disable-input'.
1354 If this is non-nil, send end-of-file as compilation process input.
1355
1356 +++
1357 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1358 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1359 in new face `next-error'.
1360
1361 +++
1362 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1363 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1364 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1365 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1366 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1367 C-c C-f.
1368
1369 +++
1370 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1371 the compilation buffer.
1372
1373 +++
1374 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1375 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1376 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1377 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1378 of the window.
1379
1380 ** Occur mode changes:
1381
1382 +++
1383 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1384 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1385 switching to it.
1386
1387 +++
1388 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1389 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1390
1391 +++
1392 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1393 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1394 `multi-occur-in-matching-buffers' which allows you to specify the
1395 buffers to search by their filenames or buffer names. Internally,
1396 Occur mode has been rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other
1397 changes.
1398
1399 ** Grep changes:
1400
1401 +++
1402 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1403
1404 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1405 customization group.
1406
1407 +++
1408 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1409 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1410
1411 +++
1412 *** New commands `lgrep' (local grep) and `rgrep' (recursive grep) are
1413 more user-friendly versions of `grep' and `grep-find', which prompt
1414 separately for the regular expression to match, the files to search,
1415 and the base directory for the search (rgrep only). Case sensitivitivy
1416 of the search is controlled by the current value of `case-fold-search'.
1417
1418 These commands build the shell commands based on the new variables
1419 `grep-template' (lgrep) and `grep-find-template' (rgrep).
1420
1421 The files to search can use aliases defined in `grep-files-aliases'.
1422
1423 Subdirectories listed in `grep-find-ignored-directories' such as those
1424 typically used by various version control systems, like CVS and arch,
1425 are automatically skipped by `rgrep'.
1426
1427 ---
1428 *** The grep commands provide highlighting support.
1429
1430 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1431 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1432
1433 ---
1434 *** The new variables `grep-window-height' and `grep-scroll-output' override
1435 the corresponding compilation mode settings, for grep commands only.
1436
1437 +++
1438 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlights matches in *grep*
1439 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1440 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1441 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1442 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1443 source line is highlighted.
1444
1445 +++
1446 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1447 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1448 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1449 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1450 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1451 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1452 file.
1453
1454 +++
1455 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1456 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1457 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1458 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1459 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1460 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1461
1462 ** X Windows Support:
1463
1464 +++
1465 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1466 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1467 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1468
1469 +++
1470 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1471 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1472 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1473 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1474 Meta and Alt:
1475 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1476 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1477
1478 +++
1479 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1480 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1481
1482 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1483 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1484
1485 ---
1486 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1487 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1488 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1489 and use the more appropriately result.
1490
1491 ---
1492 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1493 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1494 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1495
1496 ** Xterm support:
1497
1498 ---
1499 *** If you enable Xterm Mouse mode, Emacs will respond to mouse clicks
1500 on the mode line, header line and display margin, when run in an xterm.
1501
1502 ---
1503 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1504 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1505 following should work:
1506 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1507 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1508 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1509
1510 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1511
1512 +++
1513 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1514 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1515 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1516 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1517 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1518 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1519 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1520 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1521 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1522
1523 ---
1524 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1525 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1526 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1527 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1528 all of these colors.
1529
1530 +++
1531 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1532 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1533 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1534 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1535 colors as on X.
1536
1537 ---
1538 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1539 \f
1540 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1541
1542 ** ERC is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1543
1544 ERC is a powerful, modular, and extensible IRC client for Emacs.
1545
1546 To see what modules are available, type
1547 M-x customize-option erc-modules RET.
1548
1549 To start an IRC session, type M-x erc-select, and follow the prompts
1550 for server, port, and nick.
1551
1552 ---
1553 ** Rcirc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1554
1555 Rcirc is an Internet relay chat (IRC) client. It supports
1556 simultaneous connections to multiple IRC servers. Each discussion
1557 takes place in its own buffer. For each connection you can join
1558 several channels (many-to-many) and participate in private
1559 (one-to-one) chats. Both channel and private chats are contained in
1560 separate buffers.
1561
1562 To start an IRC session, type M-x irc, and follow the prompts for
1563 server, port, nick and initial channels.
1564
1565 ---
1566 ** Newsticker is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1567
1568 Newsticker asynchronously retrieves headlines (RSS) from a list of news
1569 sites, prepares these headlines for reading, and allows for loading the
1570 corresponding articles in a web browser. Its documentation is in a
1571 separate manual.
1572
1573 +++
1574 ** savehist saves minibuffer histories between sessions.
1575 To use this feature, turn on savehist-mode in your `.emacs' file.
1576
1577 +++
1578 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1579 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1580 program files that include other program files.
1581
1582 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1583 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1584 in them.
1585
1586 +++
1587 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1588
1589 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1590 Emacs Lisp. The prefix for Calc has been changed to `C-x *' and Calc
1591 can be started with `C-x * *'. The Calc manual is separate from the
1592 Emacs manual; within Emacs, type "C-h i m calc RET" to read the
1593 manual. A reference card is available in `etc/calccard.tex' and
1594 `etc/calccard.ps'.
1595
1596 ---
1597 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1598 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1599
1600 ---
1601 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1602
1603 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1604 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1605 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1606 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1607
1608 +++
1609 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1610 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1611
1612 ---
1613 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1614
1615 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1616 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1617 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1618 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1619 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1620 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1621
1622 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1623 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1624 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1625 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1626
1627 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1628 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1629 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1630 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1631 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1632 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1633 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1634
1635 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1636 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1637 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1638
1639 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1640 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1641
1642 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1643 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1644 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1645 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1646
1647 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1648 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1649 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1650 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1651
1652 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1653 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1654 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1655 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1656
1657 +++
1658 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1659
1660 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1661 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1662 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1663 capabilities.
1664
1665 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1666 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1667
1668 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1669 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1670 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1671
1672 +++
1673 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1674 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1675 to increment the SOA serial.
1676
1677 ---
1678 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1679 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1680 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1681 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1682 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticeable. The display method can
1683 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1684
1685 +++
1686 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1687 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1688
1689 +++
1690 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1691 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1692 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1693 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1694 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1695
1696 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1697 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1698 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1699 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1700 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1701 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1702
1703 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1704 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1705 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1706 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1707 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1708 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1709 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1710 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1711 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1712 or local keymaps.
1713
1714 +++
1715 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1716 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1717
1718 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1719 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1720 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1721 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1722
1723 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1724 defined macros.
1725
1726 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1727 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1728 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1729 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1730 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1731 for more commands.
1732
1733 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1734 the keyboard macro ring.
1735
1736 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1737 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1738
1739 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1740 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1741 this behavior via the variables kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1742 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1743
1744 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1745 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1746 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1747
1748 ---
1749 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1750 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1751 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1752
1753 +++
1754 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1755 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1756
1757 +++
1758 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1759 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1760 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1761 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1762 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1763 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1764 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1765 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1766 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1767
1768 +++
1769 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1770
1771 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1772 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1773 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1774 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1775 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1776 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1777
1778 ---
1779 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1780 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1781 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1782 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1783
1784 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1785
1786 ---
1787 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1788 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1789 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1790 settings.
1791
1792 +++
1793 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1794 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1795 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1796 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1797
1798 +++
1799 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1800 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1801
1802 +++
1803 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1804 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1805 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1806 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1807 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1808 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1809
1810 ** The tumme.el package allows you to easily view, tag and in other ways
1811 manipulate image files and their thumbnails, using dired as the main interface.
1812 Tumme provides functionality to generate simple image galleries.
1813
1814 +++
1815 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1816
1817 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1818 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1819 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1820 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1821 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1822 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1823 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1824 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1825 `rsync' to do the copying).
1826
1827 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1828 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1829
1830 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1831
1832 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1833
1834 Removing Tramp, and re-enabling Ange-FTP, can be achieved by M-x
1835 tramp-unload-tramp.
1836
1837 ---
1838 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1839
1840 ---
1841 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1842 configuration files.
1843
1844 +++
1845 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1846 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1847 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1848 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1849 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1850 recognized.
1851
1852 ---
1853 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1854
1855 +++
1856 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1857
1858 ---
1859 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1860 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1861
1862 ** The new package scroll-lock.el provides the Scroll Lock minor mode
1863 for pager-like scrolling. Keys which normally move point by line or
1864 paragraph will scroll the buffer by the respective amount of lines
1865 instead and point will be kept vertically fixed relative to window
1866 boundaries during scrolling.
1867
1868 ** The file t-mouse.el is now part of Emacs and provides access to mouse
1869 events from the console. It still requires gpm to work but has been updated
1870 for Emacs 22. In particular, the mode-line is now position sensitive.
1871 \f
1872 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1873
1874 ** Changes in Dired
1875
1876 +++
1877 *** Bindings for Tumme added
1878 Several new keybindings, all starting with the C-t prefix, have been
1879 added to Dired. They are all bound to commands in Tumme. As a starting
1880 point, mark some image files in a dired buffer and do C-t d to display
1881 thumbnails of them in a separate buffer.
1882
1883 ** Changes in Hi Lock
1884
1885 +++
1886 *** hi-lock-mode now only affects a single buffer, and a new function
1887 `global-hi-lock-mode' enables Hi Lock in all buffers. By default, if
1888 hi-lock-mode is used in what appears to be the initialization file, a
1889 warning message suggests to use global-hi-lock-mode instead. However,
1890 if the new variable `hi-lock-archaic-interface-deduce' is non-nil,
1891 using hi-lock-mode in an initialization file will turn on Hi Lock in all
1892 buffers and no warning will be issued (for compatibility with the
1893 behavior in older versions of Emacs).
1894
1895 ** Changes in Allout
1896
1897 *** Topic cryptography added, enabling easy gpg topic encryption and
1898 decryption. Per-topic basis enables interspersing encrypted-text and
1899 clear-text within a single file to your heart's content, using symmetric
1900 and/or public key modes. Time-limited key caching, user-provided
1901 symmetric key hinting and consistency verification, auto-encryption of
1902 pending topics on save, and more, make it easy to use encryption in
1903 powerful ways.
1904
1905 *** Default command prefix changed to "\C-c " (control-c space), to avoid
1906 intruding on user's keybinding space. Customize the
1907 `allout-command-prefix' variable to your preference.
1908
1909 *** Allout now uses text overlay's `invisible' property (and others) for
1910 concealed text, instead of selective-display. This simplifies the code, in
1911 particularly avoiding the need for kludges for isearch dynamic-display,
1912 discretionary handling of edits of concealed text, undo concerns, etc.
1913
1914 *** Many substantial fixes and refinements, including:
1915
1916 - repaired inhibition of inadvertent edits to concealed text
1917 - repaired retention of topic body hanging indent upon topic depth shifts
1918 - refuse to create "containment discontinuities", where a
1919 topic is shifted deeper than the offspring-depth of its' container
1920 - bulleting variation is simpler and more accommodating, both in the
1921 default behavior and in ability to vary when creating new topics
1922 - many internal fixes and refinements
1923 - many module and function docstring clarifications
1924 - version number incremented to 2.2
1925
1926 ** The variable `woman-topic-at-point' was renamed
1927 to `woman-use-topic-at-point' and behaves differently: if this
1928 variable is non-nil, the `woman' command uses the word at point
1929 automatically, without asking for a confirmation. Otherwise, the word
1930 at point is suggested as default, but not inserted at the prompt.
1931
1932 ---
1933 ** Changes to cmuscheme
1934
1935 *** Emacs now offers to start Scheme if the user tries to
1936 evaluate a Scheme expression but no Scheme subprocess is running.
1937
1938 *** If a file `.emacs_NAME' (where NAME is the name of the Scheme interpreter)
1939 exists in the user's home directory or in ~/.emacs.d, its
1940 contents are sent to the Scheme subprocess upon startup.
1941
1942 *** There are new commands to instruct the Scheme interpreter to trace
1943 procedure calls (`scheme-trace-procedure') and to expand syntactic forms
1944 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
1945 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
1946 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
1947
1948 ---
1949 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake.
1950
1951 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three
1952 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1953 faces.
1954
1955 +++
1956 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1957 of the file that precede the first header line.
1958
1959 +++
1960 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1961
1962 ---
1963 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1964 run most curses applications now.
1965
1966 +++
1967 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1968
1969 +++
1970 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1971 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1972 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1973
1974 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1975 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1976 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1977
1978 ---
1979 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1980 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1981
1982 ---
1983 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1984 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1985 incompatible change.
1986
1987 ---
1988 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1989
1990 +++
1991 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1992 resync points in both windows.
1993
1994 +++
1995 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1996
1997 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1998 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1999
2000 ---
2001 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
2002 when Emacs visits them.
2003
2004 ** Info mode changes:
2005
2006 +++
2007 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
2008 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
2009
2010 +++
2011 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
2012
2013 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
2014 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
2015 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
2016 around the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
2017 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
2018 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
2019 Info node.
2020
2021 ---
2022 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
2023 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
2024 search without prompting for a new search string.
2025
2026 +++
2027 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
2028 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
2029 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
2030
2031 ---
2032 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
2033
2034 ---
2035 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
2036 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
2037
2038 +++
2039 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
2040 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
2041 possible matches.
2042
2043 ---
2044 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
2045 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
2046 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
2047
2048 +++
2049 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
2050 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
2051
2052 ---
2053 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
2054 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
2055
2056 +++
2057 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
2058
2059 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
2060 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
2061
2062 ---
2063 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
2064
2065 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
2066 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
2067 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
2068
2069 +++
2070 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
2071
2072 ---
2073 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
2074
2075 ** Lisp mode changes:
2076
2077 ---
2078 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
2079
2080 +++
2081 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
2082
2083 *** New features in evaluation commands
2084
2085 +++
2086 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
2087 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
2088
2089 +++
2090 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
2091 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
2092 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
2093 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
2094 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
2095
2096 +++
2097 ** CC mode changes.
2098
2099 *** The CC Mode manual has been extensively revised.
2100 The information about using CC Mode has been separated from the larger
2101 and more difficult chapters about configuration.
2102
2103 *** Changes in Key Sequences
2104 **** c-toggle-auto-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-t.
2105
2106 **** c-toggle-hungry-state is no longer bound to C-c C-d.
2107 This binding has been taken over by c-hungry-delete-forwards.
2108
2109 **** c-toggle-auto-state (C-c C-t) has been renamed to c-toggle-auto-newline.
2110 c-toggle-auto-state remains as an alias.
2111
2112 **** The new commands c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forwards
2113 have key bindings C-c C-DEL (or C-c DEL, for the benefit of TTYs) and
2114 C-c C-d (or C-c C-<delete> or C-c <delete>) respectively. These
2115 commands delete entire blocks of whitespace with a single
2116 key-sequence. [N.B. "DEL" is the <backspace> key.]
2117
2118 **** The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l.
2119
2120 **** The new command c-subword-mode is bound to C-c C-w.
2121
2122 *** C-c C-s (`c-show-syntactic-information') now highlights the anchor
2123 position(s).
2124
2125 *** New Minor Modes
2126 **** Electric Minor Mode toggles the electric action of non-alphabetic keys.
2127 The new command c-toggle-electric-mode is bound to C-c C-l. Turning the
2128 mode off can be helpful for editing chaotically indented code and for
2129 users new to CC Mode, who sometimes find electric indentation
2130 disconcerting. Its current state is displayed in the mode line with an
2131 'l', e.g. "C/al".
2132
2133 **** Subword Minor Mode makes Emacs recognize word boundaries at upper case
2134 letters in StudlyCapsIdentifiers. You enable this feature by C-c C-w. It can
2135 also be used in non-CC Mode buffers. :-) Contributed by Masatake YAMATO.
2136
2137 *** New clean-ups
2138
2139 **** `comment-close-slash'.
2140 With this clean-up, a block (i.e. c-style) comment can be terminated by
2141 typing a slash at the start of a line.
2142
2143 **** `c-one-liner-defun'
2144 This clean-up compresses a short enough defun (for example, an AWK
2145 pattern/action pair) onto a single line. "Short enough" is configurable.
2146
2147 *** Font lock support.
2148 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
2149 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
2150 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
2151 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
2152 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
2153 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
2154
2155 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
2156 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
2157 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
2158 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
2159 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
2160 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
2161 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
2162 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
2163 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
2164
2165 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
2166 fontification in mind; Just-In-Time-Lock mode should be enabled for
2167 the highest font lock level (by default, it is). Fontifying a file
2168 with several thousand lines in one go can take the better part of a
2169 minute.
2170
2171 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
2172 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
2173 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
2174 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
2175 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
2176 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
2177
2178 **** Support for documentation comments.
2179 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
2180 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
2181 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
2182 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
2183
2184 Currently three kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Sun's
2185 Javadoc, Autodoc (which is used in Pike) and GtkDoc (used in C). (The
2186 last was contributed by Masatake YAMATO). This is by no means a
2187 complete list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor
2188 of choice is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2189
2190 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2191 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2192 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2193 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2194 parens.
2195
2196 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2197 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2198 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2199 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2200 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2201
2202 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2203 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2204 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2205 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2206 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2207
2208 *** Support for the AWK language.
2209 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2210 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2211 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2212 Here is a summary:
2213
2214 **** Indentation Engine
2215 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2216
2217 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2218 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2219 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2220 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2221 definition, or structured statement.
2222
2223 The predefined line-up functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2224 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't
2225 be any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2226
2227 **** Font Locking
2228 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2229 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2230 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2231 the AWK language itself.
2232
2233 **** Comment and Movement Commands
2234 These commands all work for AWK buffers. The notion of "defun" has
2235 been augmented to include AWK pattern-action pairs - the standard
2236 "defun" commands on key sequences C-M-a, C-M-e, and C-M-h use this
2237 extended definition.
2238
2239 **** "awk" style, Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2240 A new style, "awk" has been introduced, and this is now the default
2241 style for AWK code. With auto-newline enabled, the clean-up
2242 c-one-liner-defun (see above) is useful.
2243
2244 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2245 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2246 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2247 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2248 composition-close, and incomposition.
2249
2250 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2251 The new functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward'
2252 provide hungry deletion without having to toggle a mode. They are
2253 bound to C-c C-DEL and C-c C-d (and several variants, for the benefit
2254 of different keyboard setups. See "Changes in key sequences" above).
2255
2256 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2257
2258 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2259 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2260 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2261 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2262
2263 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2264 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2265
2266 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2267
2268 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2269 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2270 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2271 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2272
2273 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2274
2275 is now analyzed as
2276
2277 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2278
2279 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2280 symbol.
2281
2282 This change might affect code that calls `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2283 directly, and custom lineup functions if they use
2284 `c-syntactic-context'. However, the argument given to lineup
2285 functions is still a single cons cell with nil or an integer in the
2286 cdr.
2287
2288 *** API changes for derived modes.
2289
2290 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2291 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2292 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2293 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2294 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2295
2296 **** New language variable system.
2297 These are variables whose values vary between CC Mode's different
2298 languages. See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2299
2300 **** New initialization functions.
2301 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2302 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2303 `c-init-language-vars'.
2304
2305 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2306 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2307 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2308 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2309
2310 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2311 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2312 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2313 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2314 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2315
2316 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2317 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2318 its substatement. E.g:
2319
2320 if (x)
2321 x_is_true:
2322 do_stuff();
2323
2324 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2325
2326 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2327 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2328 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2329 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2330 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2331 inside `#define's.
2332
2333 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2334
2335 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2336 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2337 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2338 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2339 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2340 empty lines within the macro better.
2341
2342 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2343 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2344 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2345
2346 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2347 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2348 variable `c-backslash-max-column' puts a limit on how far out
2349 backslashes can be moved.
2350
2351 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2352 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2353 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2354 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2355
2356 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2357 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2358 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2359 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2360 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2361 backslash) in the macro.
2362
2363 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2364 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2365 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior is
2366 based on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after
2367 #else and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other
2368 cases (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2369
2370 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2371 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2372
2373 *** New lineup functions
2374
2375 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2376 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2377 continues. E.g:
2378
2379 result = prefix + "A message "
2380 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2381
2382 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2383 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2384
2385 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2386 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2387 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2388
2389 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2390 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2391
2392 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2393 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2394
2395 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2396 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2397 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2398 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2399 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2400 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2401
2402 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2403 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2404 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2405 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2406 context.
2407
2408 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2409 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2410 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2411 happen when macros are involved.
2412
2413 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2414 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2415 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2416 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2417 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2418 line is left untouched.
2419
2420 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2421 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2422 syntactic indentation.
2423
2424 ** In sh-script, a continuation line is only indented if the backslash was
2425 preceded by a SPC or a TAB.
2426
2427 ---
2428 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2429
2430 ---
2431 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2432 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2433 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2434 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2435
2436 ** Fortran mode changes:
2437
2438 ---
2439 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2440 highlighting for the old default.
2441
2442 +++
2443 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2444 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2445 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2446
2447 +++
2448 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2449 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2450 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2451 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2452
2453 ---
2454 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2455 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2456 majority.
2457
2458 ---
2459 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2460 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2461
2462 ---
2463 ** Reftex mode changes
2464
2465 +++
2466 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2467
2468 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2469 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2470 support for multifile documents.
2471
2472 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2473 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2474 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2475 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2476 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2477 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2478 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2479 with the `d' key.
2480
2481 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2482 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2483
2484 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2485 key `M-%'.
2486
2487 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2488 location.
2489
2490 +++
2491 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2492
2493 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2494 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2495 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2496
2497 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2498 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2499 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2500 citation selection buffer.
2501
2502 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2503 cursor as a default search string.
2504
2505 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2506 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2507
2508 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2509 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2510
2511 Support for jurabib has been added.
2512
2513 +++
2514 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2515
2516 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2517 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2518
2519 +++
2520 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2521
2522 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2523 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2524 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2525 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2526 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2527 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2528
2529 +++
2530 *** Miscellaneous changes
2531
2532 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2533 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2534
2535 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2536
2537 +++
2538 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2539 to support use of font-lock.
2540
2541 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2542
2543 ---
2544 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2545 automatically.
2546
2547 +++
2548 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2549 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2550 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2551 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2552 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2553 from the file name or buffer contents.
2554
2555 +++
2556 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2557
2558 ** TeX modes:
2559
2560 +++
2561 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2562
2563 +++
2564 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2565 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2566 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2567 TeX commands to use at startup.
2568
2569 ---
2570 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2571 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2572
2573 +++
2574 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2575
2576 ** BibTeX mode:
2577
2578 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2579 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2580
2581 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2582 an existing BibTeX entry by inserting fields that may occur but are not
2583 present.
2584
2585 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2586
2587 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2588 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2589 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2590 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2591 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2592 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2593
2594 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2595 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2596
2597 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2598 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2599
2600 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2601 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2602
2603 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2604 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2605
2606 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2607 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2608 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2609
2610 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2611 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2612
2613 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2614 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2615
2616 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2617 in multiple BibTeX files.
2618
2619 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2620 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2621
2622 *** The new variables bibtex-expand-strings and
2623 bibtex-autokey-expand-strings control the expansion of strings when
2624 extracting the content of a BibTeX field.
2625
2626 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and
2627 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to
2628 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and
2629 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are
2630 still available as aliases.
2631
2632 +++
2633 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2634 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2635 and `C-c C-r'.
2636
2637 ** GUD changes:
2638
2639 +++
2640 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2641 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2642
2643 ---
2644 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2645 and other common debugger commands.
2646
2647 +++
2648 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2649 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2650 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2651 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2652 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2653 Emacs 21/22 such as the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2654 breakpoints.
2655
2656 To use this package just type M-x gdb. See the Emacs manual if you want the
2657 old behaviour.
2658
2659 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2660 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2661 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2662
2663 +++
2664 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2665 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2666 not executing.
2667
2668 ---
2669 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2670
2671 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class information.
2672 Fast startup since there is no need to scan all source files up front.
2673 There is also no need to create and maintain lists of source
2674 directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath' and
2675 `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2676
2677 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2678 set/clear operations from Java source files under the classpath, stack
2679 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2680 (gud-finish).
2681
2682 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2683 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2684
2685 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2686 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2687 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2688
2689 *** Added Customization Variables
2690
2691 **** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2692
2693 **** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2694 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2695 java sources (previous method).
2696
2697 **** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for Java
2698 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2699 is nil).
2700
2701 *** Minor Improvements
2702
2703 **** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2704 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2705 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2706 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2707 `starttls' tool).
2708
2709 **** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2710
2711 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2712
2713 +++
2714 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2715
2716 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2717 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2718 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2719 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2720 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2721 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2722 be mode dependent.
2723
2724 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2725 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2726 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2727 toggles this mode.
2728
2729 +++
2730 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2731 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2732 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2733 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2734 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2735 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2736 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2737 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2738 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2739
2740 +++
2741 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2742 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2743 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2744 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2745 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2746
2747 ---
2748 ** recentf changes.
2749
2750 The recent file list is now automatically cleaned up when recentf mode is
2751 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2752 automatic cleanup.
2753
2754 The ten most recent files can be quickly opened by using the shortcut
2755 keys 1 to 9, and 0, when the recent list is displayed in a buffer via
2756 the `recentf-open-files', or `recentf-open-more-files' commands.
2757
2758 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2759 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2760 keep in the recent list.
2761
2762 With the more advanced option `recentf-filename-handlers', you can
2763 specify functions that successively transform recent file names. For
2764 example, if set to `file-truename' plus `abbreviate-file-name', the
2765 same file will not be in the recent list with different symbolic
2766 links, and the file name will be abbreviated.
2767
2768 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2769 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2770 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2771
2772 +++
2773 ** Desktop package
2774
2775 +++
2776 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2777
2778 +++
2779 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2780
2781 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2782
2783 ---
2784 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2785 buffer list.
2786
2787 +++
2788 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2789 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2790 idle).
2791
2792 +++
2793 *** New commands:
2794 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2795 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2796 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2797 it was loaded.
2798 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2799 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2800
2801 ---
2802 *** New customizable variables:
2803 - desktop-save. Determines whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2804 killed.
2805 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2806 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2807 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2808 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2809 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2810 should not delete.
2811 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2812 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2813 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2814 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2815
2816 +++
2817 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2818
2819 ---
2820 *** New hooks:
2821 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2822 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2823
2824 ---
2825 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2826
2827 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2828 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2829 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2830 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2831 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2832 feature.
2833
2834 ** EDiff changes.
2835
2836 +++
2837 *** When comparing directories.
2838 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2839 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2840 from one directory to another.
2841
2842 +++
2843 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2844 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2845 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2846 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2847 comparison.
2848
2849 +++
2850 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2851 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2852 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2853
2854 +++
2855 ** Etags changes.
2856
2857 *** New regular expressions features
2858
2859 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2860
2861 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2862 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2863 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2864 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2865 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2866 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2867 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2868 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2869 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2870 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2871
2872 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2873
2874 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2875 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2876 CR, TAB, VT.
2877
2878 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2879
2880 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2881 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2882 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2883
2884 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2885
2886 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2887 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2888
2889 *** New language parsing features
2890
2891 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2892
2893 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2894
2895 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2896
2897 **** New language HTML.
2898
2899 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2900 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2901
2902 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2903
2904 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2905 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2906
2907 **** New language Lua.
2908
2909 All functions are tagged.
2910
2911 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2912
2913 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2914 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2915 package::sub.
2916
2917 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2918
2919 **** New language PHP.
2920
2921 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2922 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2923
2924 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2925
2926 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2927 renewenvironment.
2928
2929 *** Honor #line directives.
2930
2931 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2932 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2933 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2934 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2935 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2936
2937 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2938
2939 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2940 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2941 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2942 the file FILE.
2943
2944 ** VC Changes
2945
2946 +++
2947 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2948 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2949
2950 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2951 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2952 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2953 `.emacs' file:
2954
2955 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2956
2957 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2958
2959 +++
2960 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2961 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2962
2963 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2964 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2965 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2966
2967 +++
2968 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2969
2970 +++
2971 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2972
2973 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2974 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2975 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2976
2977 P: annotates the previous revision
2978 N: annotates the next revision
2979 J: annotates the revision at line
2980 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2981 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2982 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2983 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2984
2985 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2986
2987 +++
2988 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2989 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2990 in the repository.
2991
2992 +++
2993 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2994 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2995 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2996 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2997
2998 +++
2999 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
3000 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
3001 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
3002
3003 +++
3004 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
3005
3006 See the documentation of the user option
3007 `display-time-mail-directory'.
3008
3009 ** Rmail changes:
3010
3011 ---
3012 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
3013
3014 *** The new commands rmail-end-of-message and rmail-summary end-of-message,
3015 by default bound to `/', go to the end of the current mail message in
3016 Rmail and Rmail summary buffers.
3017
3018 +++
3019 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
3020
3021 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
3022 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
3023 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
3024 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
3025 used instead of the native one.
3026
3027 ** Gnus package
3028
3029 ---
3030 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
3031
3032 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
3033 PGP/MIME.
3034
3035 ---
3036 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
3037
3038 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
3039
3040 ---
3041 ** MH-E changes.
3042
3043 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.95. There have been major changes since
3044 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
3045
3046 ** Calendar changes:
3047
3048 +++
3049 *** You can now use < and >, instead of C-x < and C-x >, to scroll
3050 the calendar left or right. (The old key bindings still work too.)
3051
3052 +++
3053 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
3054 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
3055
3056 +++
3057 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
3058 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
3059 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
3060 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
3061 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
3062 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
3063 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
3064 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
3065 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
3066
3067 +++
3068 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
3069 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
3070 count backward from the end of the year.
3071
3072 +++
3073 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
3074 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
3075 day of that ISO week.
3076
3077 ---
3078 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
3079 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
3080
3081 ---
3082 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
3083 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
3084 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
3085 `christian-holidays' simpler.
3086
3087 ---
3088 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
3089 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
3090 and `diary-header-line-format'.
3091
3092 +++
3093 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
3094 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
3095 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
3096 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
3097
3098 +++
3099 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
3100 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
3101 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
3102 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
3103 formats.
3104
3105 +++
3106 ** Speedbar changes:
3107
3108 *** Speedbar items can now be selected by clicking mouse-1, based on
3109 the `mouse-1-click-follows-link' mechanism.
3110
3111 *** SPC and DEL are no longer bound to scroll up/down in the speedbar
3112 keymap.
3113
3114 *** The new command `speedbar-toggle-line-expansion', bound to SPC,
3115 contracts or expands the line under the cursor.
3116
3117 *** New command `speedbar-create-directory', bound to `M'.
3118
3119 *** The new commands `speedbar-expand-line-descendants' and
3120 `speedbar-contract-line-descendants', bound to `[' and `]'
3121 respectively, expand and contract the line under cursor with all of
3122 its descendents.
3123
3124 *** The new user option `speedbar-query-confirmation-method' controls
3125 how querying is performed for file operations. A value of 'always
3126 means to always query before file operations; 'none-but-delete means
3127 to not query before any file operations, except before a file
3128 deletion.
3129
3130 *** The new user option `speedbar-select-frame-method' specifies how
3131 to select a frame for displaying a file opened with the speedbar. A
3132 value of 'attached means to use the attached frame (the frame that
3133 speedbar was started from.) A number such as 1 or -1 means to pass
3134 that number to `other-frame'.
3135
3136 *** The new user option `speedbar-use-tool-tips-flag', if non-nil,
3137 means to display tool-tips for speedbar items.
3138
3139 *** The frame management code in speedbar.el has been split into a new
3140 `dframe' library. Emacs Lisp code that makes use of the speedbar
3141 should use `dframe-attached-frame' instead of
3142 `speedbar-attached-frame', `dframe-timer' instead of `speedbar-timer',
3143 `dframe-close-frame' instead of `speedbar-close-frame', and
3144 `dframe-activity-change-focus-flag' instead of
3145 `speedbar-activity-change-focus-flag'. The variables
3146 `speedbar-update-speed' and `speedbar-navigating-speed' are also
3147 obsolete; use `dframe-update-speed' instead.
3148
3149 ---
3150 ** sql changes.
3151
3152 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlighting of different
3153 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
3154 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
3155 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
3156 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
3157
3158 The following values are supported:
3159
3160 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
3161 db2 DB2
3162 informix Informix
3163 ingres Ingres
3164 interbase Interbase
3165 linter Linter
3166 ms Microsoft
3167 mysql MySQL
3168 oracle Oracle
3169 postgres Postgres
3170 solid Solid
3171 sqlite SQLite
3172 sybase Sybase
3173
3174 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
3175 SQL mode indicator.
3176
3177 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
3178 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
3179 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
3180
3181 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
3182
3183 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
3184 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
3185 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
3186 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
3187
3188 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
3189 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
3190
3191 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
3192
3193 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
3194 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
3195
3196 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
3197
3198 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
3199 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
3200 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
3201 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
3202 terminated.
3203
3204 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
3205 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
3206 credentials to authenticate the user.
3207
3208 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
3209 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
3210 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
3211
3212 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
3213 Keyword highlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
3214
3215 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
3216 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
3217 defaults.
3218
3219 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
3220 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
3221 `sql-product'.
3222
3223 ---
3224 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
3225
3226 ** FFAP changes:
3227
3228 +++
3229 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
3230
3231 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
3232 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
3233 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
3234 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
3235
3236 ---
3237 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
3238
3239 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3240 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3241
3242 ---
3243 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3244
3245 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3246 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3247 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3248 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3249 with other details of skeleton construction.
3250
3251 ---
3252 ** Hideshow mode changes
3253
3254 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3255 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3256 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
3257 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
3258
3259 *** New variable `hs-allow-nesting' non-nil means that hiding a block does
3260 not discard the hidden state of any "internal" blocks; when the parent
3261 block is later shown, the internal blocks remain hidden. Default is nil.
3262
3263 +++
3264 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
3265 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
3266 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
3267
3268 ---
3269 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
3270
3271 ---
3272 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
3273 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
3274 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
3275 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
3276
3277 ---
3278 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
3279
3280 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
3281 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
3282 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
3283
3284 ---
3285 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
3286 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
3287 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
3288 using strokes as an input method.
3289
3290 ** Emacs server changes:
3291
3292 +++
3293 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
3294
3295 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
3296 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
3297 % emacsclient -s foo file1
3298 % emacsclient -s bar file2
3299
3300 +++
3301 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
3302 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
3303 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
3304
3305 +++
3306 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
3307
3308 ---
3309 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
3310
3311 +++
3312 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
3313
3314 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
3315 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
3316 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
3317
3318 ---
3319 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3320 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3321
3322 ---
3323 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3324
3325 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3326 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3327 inverse-video.
3328
3329 ---
3330 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3331
3332 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3333 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3334 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3335
3336 ** battery.el changes:
3337
3338 ---
3339 *** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3340
3341 ---
3342 *** battery.el now works on recent versions of OS X.
3343
3344 ---
3345 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3346
3347 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3348 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3349 byte boundaries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3350 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3351
3352 ---
3353 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3354
3355 ---
3356 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3357
3358 ---
3359 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3360 \f
3361 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3362
3363 +++
3364 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3365
3366 If you used a previous version of Emacs without setting the HOME
3367 environment variable and a `.emacs' was saved, then Emacs will continue
3368 using C:/ as the default HOME. But if you are installing Emacs afresh,
3369 the default location will be the "Application Data" (or similar
3370 localized name) subdirectory of your user profile. A typical location
3371 of this directory is "C:\Documents and Settings\USERNAME\Application Data",
3372 where USERNAME is your user name.
3373
3374 This change means that users can now have their own `.emacs' files on
3375 shared computers, and the default HOME directory is less likely to be
3376 read-only on computers that are administered by someone else.
3377
3378 +++
3379 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3380
3381 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3382 existing values. For example:
3383
3384 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3385
3386 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3387 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3388
3389 ---
3390 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3391
3392 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3393 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3394
3395 ---
3396 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3397
3398 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3399
3400 ---
3401 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3402
3403 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3404 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3405 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3406 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3407 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3408 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3409
3410 ---
3411 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3412
3413 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3414 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3415 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3416 sound support for those formats.
3417
3418 ---
3419 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3420
3421 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3422
3423 ---
3424 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3425
3426 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3427 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3428 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3429
3430 ---
3431 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3432
3433 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3434 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3435 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3436 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3437 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3438 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3439 you wish to use them in other faces.
3440
3441 ---
3442 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3443
3444 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3445 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3446 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3447 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3448 any customizations.
3449
3450 ---
3451 ** Running in a console window in Windows now uses the console size.
3452
3453 Previous versions of Emacs erred on the side of having a usable Emacs
3454 through telnet, even though that was inconvenient if you use Emacs in
3455 a local console window with a scrollback buffer. The default value of
3456 w32-use-full-screen-buffer is now nil, which favors local console
3457 windows. Recent versions of Windows telnet also work well with this
3458 setting. If you are using an older telnet server then Emacs detects
3459 that the console window dimensions that are reported are not sane, and
3460 defaults to 80x25. If you use such a telnet server regularly at a size
3461 other than 80x25, you can still manually set
3462 w32-use-full-screen-buffer to t.
3463
3464 ---
3465 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3466
3467 ---
3468 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3469 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3470 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3471
3472 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3473 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3474 \f
3475 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3476
3477 ---
3478 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3479 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3480
3481 +++
3482 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3483 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3484 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3485 `undefined'.)
3486
3487 +++
3488 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3489 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3490 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3491
3492 ---
3493 The function `comint-send-input' now accepts 3 optional arguments:
3494
3495 (comint-send-input &optional no-newline artificial)
3496
3497 Callers sending input not from the user should use bind the 3rd
3498 argument `artificial' to a non-nil value, to prevent Emacs from
3499 deleting the part of subprocess output that matches the input.
3500
3501 ---
3502 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3503
3504 +++
3505 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3506 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3507 \f
3508 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3509
3510 ** General Lisp changes:
3511
3512 *** The function `expt' handles negative exponents differently.
3513 The value for `(expt A B)', if both A and B are integers and B is
3514 negative, is now a float. For example: (expt 2 -2) => 0.25.
3515
3516 +++
3517 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3518
3519 +++
3520 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3521
3522 +++
3523 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3524
3525 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3526 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3527 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3528
3529 +++
3530 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3531 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3532
3533 +++
3534 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3535
3536 It recursively copies through both CARs and CDRs.
3537
3538 +++
3539 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3540
3541 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3542 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3543 first one.
3544
3545 +++
3546 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3547
3548 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3549 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3550
3551 +++
3552 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3553
3554 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3555 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3556 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3557 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3558
3559 +++
3560 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3561
3562 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3563
3564 +++
3565 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3566
3567 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3568 longer accepted.
3569
3570 +++
3571 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3572
3573 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3574 cyclic.
3575
3576 +++
3577 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3578
3579 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3580 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3581
3582 +++
3583 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3584
3585 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3586 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3587 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3588
3589 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3590 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3591
3592 +++
3593 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3594
3595 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3596 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3597 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3598
3599 +++
3600 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3601
3602 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3603 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3604 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3605
3606 +++
3607 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3608
3609 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3610 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3611 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3612 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3613
3614 +++
3615 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3616
3617 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3618 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3619 the code that has inhibited quitting exits.
3620
3621 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3622 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3623
3624 +++
3625 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3626
3627 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3628
3629 +++
3630 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3631
3632 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3633 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3634 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc.).
3635
3636 +++
3637 *** New macro `eval-at-startup' specifies expressions to
3638 evaluate when Emacs starts up. If this is done after startup,
3639 it evaluates those expressions immediately.
3640
3641 This is useful in packages that can be preloaded.
3642
3643 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3644
3645 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3646
3647 +++
3648 *** New function `string-or-null-p'.
3649
3650 Return t if OBJECT is a string or nil. Otherwise, return nil.
3651
3652 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3653
3654 +++
3655 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3656
3657 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3658 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3659
3660 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3661
3662 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3663 possible declaration specifiers are:
3664
3665 (indent INDENT)
3666 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3667
3668 (edebug DEBUG)
3669 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3670 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3671 but this is cleaner.)
3672
3673 ---
3674 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3675
3676 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3677
3678 ---
3679 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3680
3681 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3682 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3683 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3684 forms.
3685
3686 +++
3687 ** Variable aliases:
3688
3689 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3690
3691 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3692 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3693 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3694 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3695
3696 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3697 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3698
3699 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3700
3701 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3702 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3703 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3704
3705 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3706 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3707
3708 +++
3709 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3710 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3711
3712 ** defcustom changes:
3713
3714 +++
3715 *** The package-version keyword has been added to provide
3716 `customize-changed-options' functionality to packages in the future.
3717 Developers who make use of this keyword must also update the new
3718 variable `customize-package-emacs-version-alist'.
3719
3720 +++
3721 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3722
3723 ** String changes:
3724
3725 +++
3726 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3727
3728 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3729 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3730 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3731
3732 +++
3733 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3734
3735 +++
3736 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3737
3738 +++
3739 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3740 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3741 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3742 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3743 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3744
3745 +++
3746 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3747 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3748
3749 +++
3750 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3751 text properties.
3752
3753 +++
3754 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3755 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3756 been declared obsolete.
3757
3758 +++
3759 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3760
3761 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3762 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3763 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3764 warnings in a separate window.
3765
3766 +++
3767 ** Progress reporters.
3768
3769 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3770 progress messages for the user.
3771
3772 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3773 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3774 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3775
3776 ** Buffer positions:
3777
3778 +++
3779 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3780 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3781 the usable window height and width is used.
3782
3783 +++
3784 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3785 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3786 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3787 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3788 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3789
3790 +++
3791 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3792
3793 It defaults to 1.
3794
3795 +++
3796 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3797
3798 It defaults to 1.
3799
3800 +++
3801 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' tests if a position is in a clickable link.
3802
3803 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3804 functionality.
3805
3806 +++
3807 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3808
3809 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3810
3811 +++
3812 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3813
3814 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3815 give up and return LIMIT.
3816
3817 +++
3818 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3819 and partial visibility state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3820 arg is non-nil.
3821
3822 +++
3823 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3824 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3825 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3826
3827 ** Text modification:
3828
3829 +++
3830 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3831 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3832 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3833
3834 +++
3835 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3836 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3837 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3838
3839 +++
3840 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3841 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3842 inserted substring.
3843
3844 +++
3845 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3846 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3847 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3848 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3849 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3850
3851 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3852 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3853 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3854 text.
3855
3856 +++
3857 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3858 argument.
3859
3860 +++
3861 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3862 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3863 be inserted is translated through it.
3864
3865 ---
3866 *** Text clones.
3867
3868 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3869 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3870 clone to the other.
3871
3872 ---
3873 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3874
3875 ** Filling changes.
3876
3877 +++
3878 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3879 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3880 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3881
3882 +++
3883 ** Atomic change groups.
3884
3885 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3886 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3887 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3888
3889 (atomic-change-group
3890 (insert foo)
3891 (delete-region x y))
3892
3893 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3894 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3895 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3896 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3897
3898 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3899 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3900
3901 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3902 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3903 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3904 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3905
3906 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3907 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3908 do this.
3909
3910 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3911 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3912 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3913 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3914
3915 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3916 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3917 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3918 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3919 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3920 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3921 twice.
3922
3923 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3924 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3925 returned values, like this:
3926
3927 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3928 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3929
3930 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3931 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3932 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3933
3934 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3935 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3936 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3937 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3938 finished.
3939
3940 ** Buffer-related changes:
3941
3942 ---
3943 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3944
3945 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3946
3947 +++
3948 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3949
3950 +++
3951 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3952 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3953 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3954 value of VARIABLE instead.
3955
3956 *** The function `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' now lets you maintain
3957 various status records in parallel.
3958
3959 It takes a variable (a symbol) as argument. If the variable is non-nil,
3960 then its value should be a vector installed previously by
3961 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p'. If the frame names, buffer names, buffer
3962 order, or their read-only or modified flags have changed, since the
3963 time the vector's contents were recorded by a previous call to
3964 `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', then the function returns t. Otherwise
3965 it returns nil.
3966
3967 On the first call to `frame-or-buffer-changed-p', the variable's
3968 value should be nil. `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' stores a suitable
3969 vector into the variable and returns t.
3970
3971 If the variable is itself nil, then `frame-or-buffer-changed-p' uses,
3972 for compatibility, an internal variable which exists only for this
3973 purpose.
3974
3975 +++
3976 *** The function `read-buffer' follows the convention for reading from
3977 the minibuffer with a default value: if DEF is non-nil, the minibuffer
3978 prompt provided in PROMPT is edited to show the default value provided
3979 in DEF before the terminal colon and space.
3980
3981 ** Local variables lists:
3982
3983 +++
3984 *** Text properties in local variables.
3985
3986 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3987 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3988
3989 +++
3990 *** The variable `enable-local-variables' controls how local variable
3991 lists are handled. t, the default, specifies the standard querying
3992 behavior. :safe means use only safe values, and ignore the rest.
3993 nil means ignore them all. Anything else means always query.
3994
3995 +++
3996 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3997 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3998 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3999 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
4000 needed.
4001
4002 ---
4003 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
4004 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
4005 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
4006 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
4007 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
4008 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
4009
4010 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
4011 confirmation as before.
4012
4013 ** Searching and matching changes:
4014
4015 +++
4016 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
4017 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
4018 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
4019
4020 +++
4021 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
4022 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
4023 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
4024 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
4025
4026 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
4027 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
4028
4029 +++
4030 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
4031
4032 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
4033 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
4034 specified by the syntax table.
4035
4036 ---
4037 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
4038
4039 +++
4040 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
4041 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
4042 characters and ranges.
4043
4044 ---
4045 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
4046 properties from surrounding text.
4047
4048 +++
4049 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
4050 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
4051 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
4052
4053 +++
4054 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
4055 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
4056 passed to these functions will be reseated to point to nowhere.
4057
4058 +++
4059 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
4060 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
4061 that end a sentence without following spaces.
4062
4063 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
4064 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
4065 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
4066 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
4067 `sentence-end-without-space'.
4068
4069 ** Undo changes:
4070
4071 +++
4072 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
4073
4074 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
4075 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
4076 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
4077
4078 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
4079 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
4080 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
4081
4082 +++
4083 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
4084 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
4085 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
4086
4087 +++
4088 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
4089 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
4090
4091 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
4092 elements with the following format:
4093 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
4094
4095 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
4096 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
4097 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
4098 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
4099
4100 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
4101 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
4102 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
4103 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
4104 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
4105 rectangle.
4106 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
4107 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
4108 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
4109 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
4110 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
4111 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
4112 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
4113 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
4114
4115 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
4116 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
4117 the killed text.
4118
4119 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
4120 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
4121 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
4122 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
4123 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
4124
4125 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
4126 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
4127 string. The old behavior is available if you call
4128 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
4129
4130 ** Syntax table changes:
4131
4132 +++
4133 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
4134
4135 +++
4136 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
4137 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4138 of text properties as well as the character code.
4139
4140 +++
4141 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4142 by `syntax-after').
4143
4144 +++
4145 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' provides an efficient way to find the
4146 current syntactic context at point.
4147
4148 ** File operation changes:
4149
4150 +++
4151 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4152 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
4153
4154 +++
4155 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4156 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4157 operation.
4158
4159 +++
4160 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4161 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4162 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4163 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4164
4165 +++
4166 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
4167 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
4168
4169 +++
4170 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4171 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4172 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4173
4174 +++
4175 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4176
4177 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4178
4179 +++
4180 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4181 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4182
4183 +++
4184 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4185 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
4186 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
4187 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
4188
4189 +++
4190 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
4191 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
4192 tasks. For example, it can be used by the copyright package to make
4193 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
4194
4195 +++
4196 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
4197 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
4198 it's modified).
4199
4200 +++
4201 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
4202 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
4203 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
4204 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
4205 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
4206 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
4207 further filter candidate files.
4208
4209 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
4210 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
4211 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependencies.
4212
4213 ---
4214 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
4215
4216 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
4217 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
4218 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
4219 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
4220 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4221
4222 +++
4223 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
4224
4225 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
4226 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
4227 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
4228 operations.
4229
4230 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
4231 autoloaded when not really necessary.
4232
4233 +++
4234 *** The function `make-auto-save-file-name' is now handled by file
4235 name handlers. This will be exploited for remote files mainly.
4236
4237 ** Input changes:
4238
4239 +++
4240 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
4241 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
4242 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
4243
4244 +++
4245 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
4246 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
4247 it returns just the directory name.
4248
4249 ---
4250 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
4251 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4252 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4253
4254 +++
4255 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4256 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4257 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4258 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted by a quit, and t if
4259 BODY was aborted by arrival of input.
4260
4261 ** Minibuffer changes:
4262
4263 +++
4264 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4265 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4266 defaults to the current buffer.
4267
4268 +++
4269 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4270 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4271
4272 +++
4273 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4274 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4275
4276 +++
4277 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4278 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The
4279 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4280 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4281 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4282
4283 ---
4284 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
4285 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
4286
4287 +++
4288 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
4289 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
4290 `read-file-name' function.
4291
4292 +++
4293 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name.
4294
4295 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4296 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4297
4298 ** Completion changes:
4299
4300 +++
4301 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents
4302 of the minibuffer just before point. That is what completion commands
4303 operate on.
4304
4305 +++
4306 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
4307 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4308 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4309 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4310 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4311
4312 +++
4313 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4314 as a dynamic completion table.
4315
4316 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4317
4318 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4319 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4320 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4321 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4322 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4323 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4324
4325 +++
4326 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4327 as a lazy completion table.
4328
4329 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN)
4330
4331 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4332 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with no
4333 arguments. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR.
4334 If completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4335 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4336 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4337
4338 +++
4339 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
4340
4341 *** New keymaps for typing file names
4342
4343 Two new keymaps, `minibuffer-local-filename-completion-map' and
4344 `minibuffer-local-must-match-filename-map', apply whenever
4345 Emacs reads a file name in the minibuffer. These key maps override
4346 the usual binding of SPC to `minibuffer-complete-word' (so that file
4347 names with embedded spaces could be typed without the need to quote
4348 the spaces).
4349
4350 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
4351
4352 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
4353 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
4354 example,
4355
4356 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
4357
4358 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
4359
4360 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
4361 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
4362 binding and lookup functionality.
4363
4364 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
4365 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
4366 original command.
4367
4368 Example:
4369 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
4370 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
4371 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
4372 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
4373 `kill-word'.
4374
4375 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
4376 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
4377 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
4378
4379 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
4380 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
4381
4382 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
4383 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
4384
4385 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
4386 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
4387 runs `my-kill-line'.
4388
4389 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
4390
4391 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
4392 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
4393 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
4394 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
4395
4396 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
4397 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
4398
4399 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
4400 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
4401
4402 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
4403 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
4404 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
4405 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
4406 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
4407 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
4408
4409 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
4410 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
4411 command was not remapped.
4412
4413 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4414 over minor mode keymaps.
4415
4416 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
4417 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
4418 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
4419
4420 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4421
4422 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4423 bindings of the parent keymap.
4424
4425 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4426
4427 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
4428 active keymaps.
4429
4430 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
4431 defined keys and their definitions.
4432
4433 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
4434
4435 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
4436 in the keymap.
4437
4438 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
4439
4440 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4441 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4442 keymap alist to this list.
4443
4444 ** Abbrev changes:
4445
4446 +++
4447 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4448
4449 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4450
4451 +++
4452 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4453
4454 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4455 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4456 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4457 specify this flag.
4458
4459 +++
4460 ** Enhancements to process support
4461
4462 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4463 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4464
4465 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4466
4467 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4468 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4469 functions.
4470
4471 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4472 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4473
4474 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4475 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4476
4477 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4478 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4479 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4480 entire property list of a process.
4481
4482 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4483 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4484 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4485 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4486 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4487 speech synthesis.
4488
4489 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4490
4491 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4492 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4493 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4494 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4495 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4496 from such processes, allowing them to produce more output before
4497 emacs tries to read it.
4498
4499 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4500
4501 This executes a shell command synchronously in a separate process.
4502
4503 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4504 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4505 `default-directory'.
4506
4507 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4508 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4509
4510 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4511 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4512 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4513
4514 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4515 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4516
4517 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4518 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4519
4520 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4521 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4522 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4523 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4524 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4525
4526 +++
4527 ** Enhanced networking support.
4528
4529 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4530 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4531 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4532
4533 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4534 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4535 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4536 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4537 - IPv6 is supported (when available). You may explicitly select IPv6
4538 using :family 'ipv6 arg.
4539 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4540 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4541 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4542 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4543
4544 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4545 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4546 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:family ipv6))
4547
4548 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4549
4550 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4551
4552 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4553 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4554
4555 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4556
4557 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4558 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4559 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4560 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4561 string for other formatting options.
4562
4563 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4564
4565 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4566 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4567 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4568
4569 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4570 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4571
4572 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4573
4574 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4575 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4576 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4577 stopped state.
4578
4579 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4580
4581 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4582 current network addresses.
4583
4584 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4585
4586 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4587 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4588
4589 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4590
4591 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4592 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4593 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4594 "connection broken by remote peer".
4595
4596 ** Using window objects:
4597
4598 +++
4599 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4600
4601 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4602 header line.
4603
4604 +++
4605 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4606
4607 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4608 or the header line.
4609
4610 +++
4611 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4612
4613 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4614 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4615 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4616 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4617 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4618
4619 +++
4620 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4621 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4622 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4623 the mode line.
4624
4625 +++
4626 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4627 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4628
4629 +++
4630 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4631 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4632 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4633
4634 +++
4635 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4636
4637 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4638
4639 +++
4640 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4641 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4642 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4643 buffer.
4644
4645 +++
4646 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4647
4648 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4649 and scroll-bar settings.
4650
4651 +++
4652 *** The new function `window-tree' returns a frame's window tree.
4653
4654 +++
4655 *** The functions `get-lru-window' and `get-largest-window' take an optional
4656 argument `dedicated'. If non-nil, those functions do not ignore
4657 dedicated windows.
4658
4659 +++
4660 *** The new function `adjust-window-trailing-edge' moves the right
4661 or bottom edge of a window. It does not move other window edges.
4662
4663 +++
4664 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4665
4666 *** New buffer-local variables `fringe-indicator-alist' and
4667 `fringe-cursor-alist' maps between logical (internal) fringe indicator
4668 and cursor symbols and the actual fringe bitmaps to be displayed.
4669 This decouples the logical meaning of the fringe indicators from the
4670 physical appearance, as well as allowing different fringe bitmaps to
4671 be used in different windows showing different buffers.
4672
4673 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4674 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4675
4676 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4677 identifying the bitmap such as `left-truncation' or `continued-line'.
4678
4679 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4680 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4681
4682 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4683 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4684 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4685 foreground color of the bitmap.
4686
4687 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4688 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4689 bitmap of the display line.
4690
4691 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4692 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4693 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4694 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4695 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4696
4697 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4698 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4699
4700 ** Other window fringe features:
4701
4702 +++
4703 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4704
4705 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4706 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4707 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4708 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4709
4710 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4711 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4712 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4713 between the left and right fringe. To force a specific fringe width,
4714 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4715 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4716
4717 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4718 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4719 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4720 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4721
4722 +++
4723 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4724
4725 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4726 position settings.
4727
4728 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4729 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4730 `set-window-fringes'.
4731
4732 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4733 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4734 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4735 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4736
4737 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4738 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4739 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4740 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4741 an update of the display margins.
4742
4743 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4744 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4745
4746 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4747 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4748 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4749 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4750 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4751 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4752 of the display margins.
4753
4754 ** Redisplay features:
4755
4756 +++
4757 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4758
4759 +++
4760 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4761 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4762 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4763 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4764 forcing an explicit window update.
4765
4766 +++
4767 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4768 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4769 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4770
4771 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4772 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4773
4774 +++
4775 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4776 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4777
4778 It contains a list of variables which contain overlay arrow position
4779 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4780
4781 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4782 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4783 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4784 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4785 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4786 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4787
4788 +++
4789 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4790
4791 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4792 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4793
4794 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4795 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4796 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4797 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4798 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4799
4800 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4801 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4802 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4803
4804 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4805 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4806 the given value.
4807
4808 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4809 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4810 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4811
4812 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4813 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4814
4815 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4816 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4817 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4818 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4819 exactly that many pixels high.
4820
4821 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4822 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4823 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4824 the `line-spacing' variable.
4825
4826 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4827 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4828
4829 +++
4830 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4831 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4832
4833 +++
4834 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4835
4836 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4837 PROPS is a property list, now allows pixel based width and height
4838 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4839
4840 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4841 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4842 are supported:
4843
4844 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4845 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4846 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4847 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4848 | scroll-bar | text
4849 POS ::= left | center | right
4850 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4851 OP ::= + | -
4852
4853 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4854 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4855 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4856 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4857 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4858 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4859 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4860 the image.
4861
4862 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4863 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4864 corresponding area of the window.
4865
4866 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4867 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4868 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4869 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4870 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4871 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4872 these symbols), further occurrences of these symbols are interpreted as
4873 the width of the area.
4874
4875 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4876 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4877
4878 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4879 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4880 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4881
4882 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4883 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4884 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4885 height) of the specified image.
4886
4887 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4888 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4889
4890 +++
4891 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4892 text property string that may be present at the current window
4893 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4894 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4895
4896 +++
4897 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4898 supported on text terminals.
4899
4900 +++
4901 *** Support for displaying image slices
4902
4903 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4904 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4905
4906 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4907 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4908
4909 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4910 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4911
4912 +++
4913 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4914
4915 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4916 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4917 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4918 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4919 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4920 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4921 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4922 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4923
4924 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4925 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4926 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4927 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4928 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4929 for possible pointer shapes.
4930
4931 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4932 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4933 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4934
4935 +++
4936 *** The function `find-image' now searches in etc/images/ and etc/.
4937 The new variable `image-load-path' is a list of locations in which to
4938 search for image files. The default is to search in etc/images, then
4939 in etc/, and finally in the directories specified by `load-path'.
4940 Subdirectories of etc/ and etc/images are not recursively searched; if
4941 you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to specify it
4942 explicitly; for example, if an image is put in etc/images/foo/bar.xpm:
4943
4944 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm")))
4945
4946 Note that all images formerly located in the lisp directory have been
4947 moved to etc/images.
4948
4949 +++
4950 *** New function `image-load-path-for-library' returns a suitable
4951 search path for images relative to library. This function is useful in
4952 external packages to save users from having to update
4953 `image-load-path'.
4954
4955 +++
4956 *** The new variable `max-image-size' defines the maximum size of
4957 images that Emacs will load and display.
4958
4959 ** Mouse pointer features:
4960
4961 +++ (lispref)
4962 ??? (man)
4963 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4964 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4965 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4966 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4967 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4968
4969 +++
4970 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4971 :pointer image property.
4972
4973 +++
4974 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4975 controlled/overridden via the `pointer' text property.
4976
4977 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4978
4979 +++
4980 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4981 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4982
4983 +++
4984 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4985 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4986 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4987
4988 +++
4989 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4990
4991 +++
4992 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4993
4994 +++
4995 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4996 text area).
4997
4998 +++
4999 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
5000 and all areas.
5001
5002 +++
5003 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
5004 of the mouse event position.
5005
5006 +++
5007 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
5008
5009 +++
5010 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
5011 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
5012
5013 +++
5014 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
5015 (image or character) clicked on.
5016
5017 +++
5018 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
5019
5020 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
5021 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
5022 the total width and height of that object.
5023
5024 ** Text property and overlay changes:
5025
5026 +++
5027 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
5028 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
5029
5030 +++
5031 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5032
5033 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
5034 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
5035 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
5036 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
5037
5038 +++
5039 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
5040 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
5041 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
5042 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
5043 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
5044
5045 +++
5046 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
5047
5048 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
5049 property names as argument rather than a property list.
5050
5051 ** Face changes
5052
5053 +++
5054 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
5055 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
5056 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
5057 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
5058 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
5059 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
5060
5061 +++
5062 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
5063 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
5064
5065 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
5066 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
5067 defined with `defface'.
5068
5069 ---
5070 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
5071 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
5072 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
5073 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
5074 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
5075
5076 +++
5077 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
5078 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
5079 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
5080 by them).
5081
5082 +++
5083 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
5084 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
5085 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
5086 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
5087 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
5088
5089 ---
5090 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
5091 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
5092 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
5093
5094 +++
5095 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
5096
5097 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
5098 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
5099 attribute.
5100
5101 +++
5102 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
5103 help with handling relative face attributes.
5104
5105 +++
5106 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
5107
5108 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
5109 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
5110 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
5111 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
5112 `face' properties.
5113
5114 ---
5115 *** On terminals, faces with the :inverse-video attribute are displayed
5116 with swapped foreground and background colors even when one of them is
5117 not specified. In previous releases of Emacs, if either foreground
5118 or background color was unspecified, colors were not swapped. This
5119 was inconsistent with the face behavior under X.
5120
5121 ---
5122 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
5123 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
5124
5125 ** Font-Lock changes:
5126
5127 +++
5128 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
5129
5130 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
5131 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
5132 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
5133 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
5134
5135 +++
5136 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
5137
5138 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
5139 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
5140 properties than `face'.
5141
5142 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
5143 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
5144
5145 ---
5146 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
5147
5148 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
5149 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
5150 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
5151 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
5152 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
5153
5154 s{
5155 foo
5156 }{
5157 bar
5158 }e
5159
5160 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
5161 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
5162 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
5163 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
5164
5165 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
5166
5167 +++
5168 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
5169 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
5170 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
5171 variable `magic-mode-alist'.
5172
5173 +++
5174 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
5175
5176 +++
5177 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
5178 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
5179 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
5180
5181 ---
5182 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
5183 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
5184 it in that buffer.
5185
5186 +++
5187 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
5188 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
5189 the language.
5190
5191 +++
5192 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
5193 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
5194
5195 +++
5196 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
5197 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
5198 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
5199
5200 ** Minor mode changes:
5201
5202 +++
5203 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
5204 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
5205
5206 +++
5207 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5208
5209 +++
5210 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
5211
5212 This is a new name for what was formerly called
5213 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
5214
5215 ** Command loop changes:
5216
5217 +++
5218 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
5219 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
5220 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
5221
5222 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
5223 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
5224
5225 +++
5226 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
5227
5228 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
5229 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
5230 macros.
5231
5232 +++
5233 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
5234 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
5235 covered by an image or composition property.
5236
5237 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
5238 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
5239 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
5240 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
5241 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5242
5243 +++
5244 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
5245 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
5246 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
5247 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
5248 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
5249
5250 +++
5251 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
5252 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
5253 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
5254
5255 +++
5256 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
5257 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
5258
5259 ** Lisp file loading changes:
5260
5261 +++
5262 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
5263 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
5264 current file redefined it).
5265
5266 +++
5267 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
5268 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
5269
5270 +++
5271 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
5272 variable or face definitions.
5273
5274 +++
5275 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
5276 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
5277 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
5278
5279 ---
5280 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
5281 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
5282 than 3 levels of nesting.
5283
5284 +++
5285 ** Byte compiler changes:
5286
5287 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
5288 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
5289 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
5290 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
5291 compilation output buffer.
5292
5293 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
5294 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
5295
5296 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
5297 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
5298 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
5299 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
5300 forms:
5301
5302 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
5303 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
5304
5305 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
5306 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
5307 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
5308 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
5309 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
5310 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
5311
5312 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
5313 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
5314 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
5315 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
5316 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
5317 you anything.
5318
5319 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
5320
5321 ---
5322 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
5323 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
5324 (require 'cl) when loaded.
5325
5326 ** Frame operations:
5327
5328 +++
5329 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
5330
5331 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
5332 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
5333
5334 +++
5335 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5336 for all (existing and future) frames.
5337
5338 +++
5339 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
5340 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
5341 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
5342 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
5343
5344 +++
5345 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
5346 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
5347
5348 ** Mule changes:
5349
5350 +++
5351 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
5352
5353 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
5354 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
5355 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
5356 now:
5357
5358 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
5359
5360 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
5361 the time it takes to convert the format.
5362
5363 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
5364 wasteful.
5365
5366 ---
5367 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
5368 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
5369
5370 +++
5371 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
5372 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
5373 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
5374 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
5375
5376 ---
5377 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
5378 of one coding system from another coding system.
5379
5380 ---
5381 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
5382 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
5383 parts, e.g. utf-16.
5384
5385 +++
5386 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
5387 it is read from a file without decoding.
5388
5389 ---
5390 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
5391 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
5392
5393 ---
5394 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
5395 current input method to input a character.
5396
5397 ** Mode line changes:
5398
5399 +++
5400 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
5401
5402 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
5403 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
5404
5405 +++
5406 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
5407 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
5408
5409 +++
5410 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
5411 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
5412 line.
5413
5414 +++
5415 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
5416
5417 ** Menu manipulation changes:
5418
5419 ---
5420 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
5421 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
5422 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
5423 several versions ago.
5424
5425 ---
5426 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
5427 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
5428 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
5429
5430 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
5431 made with easy-menu.
5432
5433 ---
5434 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
5435 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
5436 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
5437 need to have a name.
5438
5439 ** Operating system access:
5440
5441 +++
5442 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
5443 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
5444
5445 +++
5446 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
5447 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
5448 accepts a float as UID parameter.
5449
5450 +++
5451 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
5452
5453 ---
5454 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
5455 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
5456 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
5457
5458 ---
5459 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
5460 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
5461
5462 ** Miscellaneous:
5463
5464 +++
5465 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
5466
5467 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
5468 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
5469 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
5470 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
5471 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
5472 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
5473 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
5474
5475 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
5476
5477 +++
5478 *** Variable `local-write-file-hooks' is marked obsolete.
5479
5480 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
5481
5482 ---
5483 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
5484 running under X.
5485
5486 ** GC changes:
5487
5488 +++
5489 *** New variable `gc-cons-percentage' automatically grows the GC cons threshold
5490 as the heap size increases.
5491
5492 +++
5493 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
5494 on garbage collection.
5495
5496 +++
5497 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5498
5499 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5500 \f
5501 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5502
5503 +++
5504 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5505 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5506 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5507 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5508 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5509
5510 ---
5511 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5512 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5513 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5514
5515 +++
5516 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5517 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5518 data structures.
5519
5520 ---
5521 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5522 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5523
5524 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5525 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5526 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5527 commands.
5528
5529 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5530 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5531 SQL buffer.
5532
5533 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5534 (function (lambda ()
5535 (master-mode t)
5536 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5537 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5538 (function (lambda ()
5539 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5540
5541 +++
5542 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5543
5544 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5545
5546 +++
5547 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5548
5549 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5550 code. It works with edebug.
5551
5552 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5553 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5554 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5555 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5556 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5557
5558 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5559 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5560 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5561 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5562 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5563 value, such as (setq x 14).
5564
5565 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5566 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5567 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5568 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5569 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5570 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5571 \f
5572 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5573
5574 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5575 been added.
5576
5577 \f
5578 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5579
5580 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5581 with Custom.
5582
5583 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5584 as mule-utf-8.
5585
5586 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5587 in UTF-8 locales).
5588
5589 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5590 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5591 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5592 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5593 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5594 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5595 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5596 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5597 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5598 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5599
5600 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5601 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5602
5603 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5604 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5605 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5606 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5607 contrary to the compound text specification.
5608
5609 \f
5610 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5611
5612 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5613
5614 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5615
5616 \f
5617 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5618
5619 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5620
5621 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5622 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5623 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5624 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5625 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5626
5627 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5628 were changed.
5629
5630 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5631 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5632
5633 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5634 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5635 instead of using default-major-mode.
5636
5637 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5638 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5639 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5640 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5641 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5642 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5643 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5644
5645 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5646 NEWS.
5647
5648 \f
5649 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5650
5651 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5652 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5653 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5654
5655 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5656 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5657
5658 \f
5659 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5660
5661 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5662 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5663 charsets in this release.
5664
5665 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5666
5667 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5668
5669 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5670 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5671 to list them.
5672
5673 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5674 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5675 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5676 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5677 necessary changes to unexec.
5678
5679 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5680 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5681
5682 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5683 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5684
5685 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5686 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5687
5688 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5689 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5690 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5691 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5692 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5693
5694 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5695 new display features described below.
5696
5697 \f
5698 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5699
5700 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5701
5702 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5703 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5704 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5705 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5706 the text.
5707
5708 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5709
5710 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5711 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5712 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5713 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5714 specify a font.
5715
5716 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5717 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5718 under Lisp changes, below.
5719
5720 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5721
5722 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5723 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5724 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5725 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5726 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5727 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5728 on terminals.
5729
5730 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5731 supported on character terminals.
5732
5733 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5734 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5735 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5736 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5737
5738 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5739
5740 ** Sound support
5741
5742 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5743 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5744 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5745 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5746 sound support.
5747
5748 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5749
5750 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5751 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5752 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5753 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5754
5755 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5756
5757 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5758 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5759 specifies a number of lines.
5760
5761 Default is 0.25.
5762
5763 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5764
5765 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5766 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5767 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5768 again.
5769
5770 Default is `grow-only'.
5771
5772 ** LessTif support.
5773
5774 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5775 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5776
5777 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5778
5779 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5780 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5781 non-nil.
5782
5783 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5784
5785 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5786 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5787 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5788
5789 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5790
5791 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5792 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5793 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5794 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5795 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5796 Emacs.
5797
5798 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5799 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5800 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5801 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5802 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5803 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5804
5805 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5806 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5807 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5808 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5809 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5810 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5811
5812 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5813 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5814 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5815 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5816 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5817
5818 ** Tool bar support.
5819
5820 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5821 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5822 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5823 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5824 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5825 icons will be used.
5826
5827 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5828 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5829
5830 ** Tooltips.
5831
5832 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5833 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5834 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5835
5836 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5837 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5838 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5839 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5840
5841 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5842
5843 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5844 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5845 customized.
5846
5847 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5848 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5849 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5850 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5851 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5852
5853 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5854 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5855 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5856 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5857 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5858 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5859
5860 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5861 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5862 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5863 customizing face `fringe'.
5864
5865 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5866 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5867 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5868 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5869 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5870 the window to be partially obscured.)
5871
5872 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5873 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5874 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5875 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5876
5877 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5878
5879 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5880 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5881 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5882 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5883 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5884 have enabled one.
5885
5886 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5887
5888 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5889
5890 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5891
5892 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5893 `*') toggles the status.
5894
5895 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5896
5897 ** Hourglass pointer
5898
5899 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5900 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5901
5902 ** Blinking cursor
5903
5904 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5905 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5906 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5907 the group `cursor'.
5908
5909 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5910
5911 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5912 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5913 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5914 details.
5915
5916 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5917 have to do anything to activate it.
5918
5919 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5920
5921 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5922 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5923
5924 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5925 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5926 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5927 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5928 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5929 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5930 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5931 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5932
5933 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5934 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5935 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5936 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5937 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5938 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5939
5940 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5941 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5942
5943 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5944 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5945 buffer by default.
5946
5947 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5948 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5949 beginning and end of the buffer.
5950
5951 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5952 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5953 signaled.
5954
5955 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5956 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5957
5958 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5959 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5960 this behavior.
5961
5962 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5963 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5964 Emacs dump core.
5965
5966 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5967
5968 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5969 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5970 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5971
5972 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5973 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5974 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5975
5976 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5977 using that menu.
5978
5979 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5980
5981 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5982 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5983 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5984 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5985 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5986 whitespace.
5987
5988 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5989 all frames except the selected one.
5990
5991 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5992 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5993
5994 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5995 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5996 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5997 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5998 `Info-use-header-line'.
5999
6000 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
6001 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
6002 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
6003
6004 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
6005
6006 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
6007 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
6008 `fr-drdref.tex'.
6009
6010 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
6011 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
6012 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
6013 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
6014
6015 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
6016
6017 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
6018 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
6019 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
6020 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
6021
6022 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
6023 point in a pop-up window.
6024
6025 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
6026 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
6027 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
6028
6029 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
6030 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
6031
6032 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
6033 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
6034 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
6035 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
6036
6037 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
6038
6039 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6040 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6041
6042 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
6043 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
6044 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
6045
6046 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
6047 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
6048 non-nil.
6049
6050 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
6051 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
6052 file that is already visited under a different name.
6053
6054 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
6055 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
6056
6057 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
6058 and displays information about that.
6059
6060 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
6061 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
6062
6063 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
6064 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
6065 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
6066 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
6067 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
6068 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
6069
6070 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
6071 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
6072
6073 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
6074 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
6075 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
6076 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
6077 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
6078 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
6079 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
6080
6081 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
6082 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
6083
6084 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
6085 system for keyboard input.
6086
6087 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
6088 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
6089 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
6090 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
6091 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
6092 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
6093 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
6094 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
6095 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
6096
6097 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
6098 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
6099
6100 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
6101 displays all characters in that character set.
6102
6103 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
6104 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
6105
6106 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
6107 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
6108 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
6109
6110 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
6111 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
6112 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
6113 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
6114 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
6115 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
6116 and Polish `slash'.
6117
6118 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
6119 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
6120 of the tutorial.
6121
6122 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
6123 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
6124 Lisp Coding Convention".
6125
6126 new command old-binding
6127 --- ------- -----------
6128 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
6129 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
6130 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
6131
6132 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
6133 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
6134 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
6135
6136 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
6137 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
6138 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
6139 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
6140 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
6141 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
6142
6143 ** There are new Leim input methods.
6144 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
6145 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
6146 package.
6147
6148 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
6149 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
6150 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
6151 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
6152 "`", you must type "=q".
6153
6154 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6155 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6156 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6157 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6158 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6159 on.
6160
6161 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6162 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6163 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6164 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6165
6166 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6167 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6168 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6169 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6170
6171 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6172 on the display using several methods
6173
6174 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6175 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6176 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6177
6178 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6179 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6180
6181 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6182
6183 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6184 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6185
6186 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6187 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6188 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6189 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6190
6191 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6192 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6193 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6194
6195 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6196 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6197
6198 ** New X resources recognized
6199
6200 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6201 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6202 is useful for debugging X problems.
6203
6204 Example:
6205
6206 emacs.synchronous: true
6207
6208 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6209 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6210 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6211 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6212 visual class names are
6213
6214 TrueColor
6215 PseudoColor
6216 DirectColor
6217 StaticColor
6218 GrayScale
6219 StaticGray
6220
6221 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6222 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6223 meaning.
6224
6225 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6226 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6227 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6228 visual.
6229
6230 Example:
6231
6232 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6233
6234 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6235 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6236 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6237 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6238
6239 Example:
6240
6241 emacs.privateColormap: true
6242
6243 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6244
6245 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6246 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6247 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6248 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6249 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6250 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6251 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6252
6253 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6254 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6255 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6256 `default' face and vice versa.
6257
6258 ** New face `menu'.
6259
6260 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6261
6262 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6263
6264 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6265 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6266 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6267 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6268
6269 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6270 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6271 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6272
6273 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6274 `ScreenGamma'.
6275
6276 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6277
6278 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6279 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6280 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6281 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6282
6283 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6284
6285 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6286
6287 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6288
6289 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6290 LessTif/Motif one.
6291
6292 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6293 LessTif and Motif.
6294
6295 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6296
6297 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6298 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6299 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6300
6301 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6302 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6303
6304 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6305 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6306 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6307
6308 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6309
6310 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6311 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6312 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6313 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6314
6315 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6316 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6317 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6318 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6319
6320 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6321 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6322 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6323 buffers.
6324
6325 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6326
6327 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6328 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6329 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6330
6331 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6332 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6333 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6334 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6335 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6336 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6337
6338 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6339
6340 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6341 notably at the end of lines.
6342
6343 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6344 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6345
6346 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6347
6348 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6349 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6350
6351 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6352 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6353 after each match to get the replacement text.
6354
6355 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6356 you edit the replacement string.
6357
6358 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6359 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6360 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6361
6362 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6363
6364 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6365 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6366
6367 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6368 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6369 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6370 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6371
6372 --
6373 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6374 read mail from the menu etc.
6375
6376 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6377 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6378 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6379 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6380
6381 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6382 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6383
6384 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6385 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6386 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6387 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6388 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6389 of Emacs.
6390
6391 ** Customize changes
6392
6393 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6394 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6395 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6396 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6397 earlier versions of Emacs.
6398
6399 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6400 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6401 default).
6402
6403 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6404 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6405 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6406 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6407 file.
6408
6409 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6410 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6411 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6412 already in your init file.
6413
6414 ** New features in evaluation commands
6415
6416 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6417 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6418 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6419 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6420 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6421
6422 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6423 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6424 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6425 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6426 printed).
6427
6428 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6429 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6430
6431 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6432 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6433
6434 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6435 code when called with a prefix argument.
6436
6437 ** CC mode changes.
6438
6439 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6440 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6441 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6442 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6443 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6444 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6445 release.
6446
6447 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6448 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6449 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6450 confusion.
6451
6452 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6453 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6454 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6455 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6456
6457 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6458 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6459
6460 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6461 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6462
6463 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6464 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6465 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6466 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6467
6468 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6469 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6470 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6471 earlier statement. An example:
6472
6473 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6474 if (a[i])
6475 res += a[i]->offset;
6476 else
6477
6478 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6479 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6480 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6481 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6482 the preceding "if".
6483
6484 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6485 by default.
6486
6487 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6488 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6489 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6490 documentation or other natural language text.
6491
6492 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6493 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6494 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6495 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6496 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6497 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6498 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6499
6500 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6501 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6502 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6503 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6504
6505 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6506 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6507 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6508 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6509 Pike mode only.
6510
6511 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6512 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6513 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6514 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6515 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6516 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6517 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6518 is reported afterwards.
6519
6520 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6521 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6522 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6523
6524 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6525 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6526 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6527 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6528 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6529 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6530 groundwork.
6531
6532 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6533 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6534 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6535 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6536 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6537 have to bother.
6538
6539 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6540 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6541 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6542 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6543 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6544 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6545
6546 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6547 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6548 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6549 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6550 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6551 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6552 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6553 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6554
6555 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6556 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6557 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6558 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6559 above.
6560
6561 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6562 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6563 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6564 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6565 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6566 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6567 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6568 function documentation for more info.
6569
6570 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6571 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6572 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6573 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6574 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6575 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6576 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6577 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6578
6579 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6580
6581 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6582 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6583
6584 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6585 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6586 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6587 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6588 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6589 style system.
6590
6591 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6592 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6593 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6594 as far as possible.
6595
6596 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6597 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6598 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6599 chapter about this in the manual.
6600
6601 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6602 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6603 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6604 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6605 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6606
6607 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6608 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6609 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6610
6611 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6612 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6613
6614 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6615 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6616 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6617 inside CC Mode.
6618
6619 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6620 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6621 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6622 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6623 cc-mode/).
6624
6625 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6626 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6627 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6628 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6629 they were before the filling.
6630
6631 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6632 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6633 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6634 literals.
6635
6636 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6637 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6638 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6639 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6640 this function.
6641
6642 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6643 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6644 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6645 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6646 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6647
6648 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6649 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6650 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6651
6652 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6653
6654 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6655 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6656 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6657 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6658
6659 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6660 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6661 the column specified by comment-column.
6662
6663 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6664 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6665 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6666 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6667 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6668 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6669
6670 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6671 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6672 arguments.
6673
6674 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6675
6676 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6677 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6678 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6679 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6680 Provan).
6681
6682 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6683
6684 ** Dired changes
6685
6686 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6687 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6688 is, delete only empty directories.
6689
6690 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6691 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6692 copy directories recursively.
6693
6694 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6695 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6696 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6697
6698 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6699 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6700 directory.
6701
6702 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6703 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6704 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6705 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6706 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6707
6708 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6709 from ls switches.
6710
6711 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6712 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6713 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6714 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6715
6716 ** Gnus changes.
6717
6718 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6719 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6720 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6721
6722 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6723 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6724
6725 If you used procmail like in
6726
6727 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6728 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6729 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6730 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6731
6732 this now has changed to
6733
6734 (setq mail-sources
6735 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6736 :suffix ".in")))
6737
6738 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6739 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6740
6741 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6742 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6743 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6744 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6745
6746 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6747 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6748 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6749
6750 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6751 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6752 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6753 now just a compatibility layer.
6754
6755 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6756 Gnus facilities.
6757
6758 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6759 called to position point.
6760
6761 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6762 summary buffers and NOV files.
6763
6764 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6765 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6766
6767 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6768 subtly different manner.
6769
6770 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6771 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6772 ever-changing layouts.
6773
6774 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6775
6776 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6777
6778 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6779
6780 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6781 macros
6782
6783 Key binding Macro
6784 -------------------------
6785 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6786 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6787 C-c C-c u @uref
6788 C-c C-c q @quotation
6789 C-c C-c m @email
6790 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6791 M-RET @item
6792
6793 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6794
6795 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6796
6797 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6798 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6799 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6800
6801 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6802
6803 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6804 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6805 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6806 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6807 buffers to kill, as before.
6808
6809 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6810 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6811 this way.
6812
6813 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6814 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6815
6816 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6817
6818 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6819 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6820 use. Default is 1000.
6821
6822 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6823 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6824
6825 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6826
6827 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6828
6829 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6830 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6831 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6832 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6833
6834 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6835 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6836 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6837 the open block.
6838
6839 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6840 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6841 the normal block-hiding function.
6842
6843 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6844
6845 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6846 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6847 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6848 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6849
6850 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6851 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6852
6853 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6854
6855 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6856 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6857 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6858
6859 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6860 current buffer.
6861
6862 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6863 in a log file.
6864
6865 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6866 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6867 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6868 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6869 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6870 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6871
6872 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6873
6874 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6875
6876 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6877 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6878
6879 ** Changes in Font Lock
6880
6881 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6882 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6883
6884 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6885 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6886
6887 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6888 the face used for each string/comment.
6889
6890 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6891 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6892
6893 ** Changes to Shell mode
6894
6895 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6896 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6897 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6898 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6899
6900 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6901
6902 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6903 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6904
6905 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6906 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6907 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6908 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6909 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6910 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6911
6912 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6913 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6914 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6915 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6916 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6917 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6918 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6919 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6920
6921 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6922 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6923
6924 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6925 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6926 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6927
6928 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6929 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6930 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6931
6932 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6933 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6934 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6935
6936 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6937 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6938 argument, it appends to the file.
6939
6940 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6941 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6942 compatibility.
6943
6944 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6945 ring (history).
6946
6947 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6948 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6949 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6950
6951 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6952
6953 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6954 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6955 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6956 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6957 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6958 as correspondent.
6959
6960 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6961 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6962 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6963
6964 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6965 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6966 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6967 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6968 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6969
6970 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6971 like `j'.
6972
6973 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6974 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6975 digest message.
6976
6977 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6978 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6979
6980 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6981 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6982 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6983
6984 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6985 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6986
6987 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6988 use the -f option when sending mail.
6989
6990 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6991 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6992 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6993 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6994 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6995 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6996
6997 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6998 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6999 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
7000
7001 ** Changes to TeX mode
7002
7003 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
7004 `latex-mode'.
7005
7006 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
7007
7008 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
7009
7010 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
7011
7012 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
7013
7014 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
7015 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
7016 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
7017 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
7018 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
7019 can be edited from that buffer.
7020
7021 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
7022 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
7023 `A' to use all marked entries).
7024
7025 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
7026 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
7027
7028 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
7029 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
7030 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
7031 been cited.
7032
7033 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
7034 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
7035 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
7036 in column 1 are always made leaves.
7037
7038 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
7039 has the following new features:
7040
7041 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
7042 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
7043 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
7044 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
7045
7046 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
7047 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
7048 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
7049 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
7050 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
7051 defaults to 1.
7052
7053 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
7054 file names.
7055
7056 ** Ispell changes
7057
7058 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
7059 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
7060 spell-checks the current buffer.
7061
7062 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
7063 added.
7064
7065 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
7066 correction is made and re-checked.
7067
7068 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
7069
7070 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
7071 cases.
7072
7073 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
7074 on syntax errors.
7075
7076 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
7077 end of the buffer.
7078
7079 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
7080
7081 ** Makefile mode changes
7082
7083 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
7084
7085 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
7086 Fontlock mode is active.
7087
7088 ** Isearch changes
7089
7090 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
7091 so that searches can be resumed.
7092
7093 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
7094 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
7095 that started the search.
7096
7097 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
7098 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
7099
7100 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
7101
7102 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
7103 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
7104 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
7105 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
7106 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
7107 `secondary-selection'.
7108
7109 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
7110 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
7111 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
7112 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
7113 usual snappy response.
7114
7115 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
7116 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
7117 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
7118 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
7119
7120 ** VC Changes
7121
7122 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
7123 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
7124 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
7125 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
7126 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
7127 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
7128 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
7129 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
7130 file is registered in that backend.
7131
7132 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
7133 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
7134 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
7135 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
7136 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
7137 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
7138
7139 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
7140 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
7141 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
7142 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
7143 where it doesn't make sense.)
7144
7145 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
7146 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
7147 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
7148
7149 *** General Changes
7150
7151 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
7152 checks are always done now.
7153
7154 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7155 operations.
7156
7157 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7158 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7159 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7160
7161 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7162 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7163 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7164 the working file (``merge news'').
7165
7166 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7167 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7168 downwards.
7169
7170 *** Multiple Backends
7171
7172 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7173 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7174 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7175 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7176 local RCS archives.
7177
7178 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7179 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7180 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7181 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7182
7183 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7184 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7185 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7186 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7187 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7188
7189 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7190 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7191 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7192 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7193
7194 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7195 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7196 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7197 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7198
7199 *** Changes for CVS
7200
7201 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7202 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7203 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7204 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7205 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7206 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7207 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7208
7209 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7210 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7211 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7212 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7213 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7214 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7215 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7216 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7217 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7218 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7219 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7220 name.)
7221
7222 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7223 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7224 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7225 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7226 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7227 entire directory tree.
7228
7229 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7230 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7231 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7232 "watched" by other developers.)
7233
7234 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7235 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7236 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7237 starting at the given directory.
7238
7239 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7240
7241 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7242 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7243 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7244 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7245 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7246 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7247 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7248 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7249 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7250
7251 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7252 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7253 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7254 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7255
7256 ** New modes and packages
7257
7258 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7259 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7260 the default is not applicable.
7261
7262 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7263 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7264 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7265
7266 Features are:
7267
7268 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7269 drawn, like this: | \ /
7270 --+-- X
7271 | / \
7272
7273 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7274 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7275 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7276 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7277 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7278 you are drawing.
7279
7280 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7281 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7282
7283 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7284 flood-filling.
7285
7286 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7287 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7288 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7289 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7290
7291 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7292 also do without the mouse.
7293
7294 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7295 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7296 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7297 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7298 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7299
7300 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7301
7302 lines straight-lines
7303 rectangles squares
7304 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7305 ellipses circles
7306 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7307 spray-can setting size for spraying
7308 vaporize line vaporize lines
7309 erase characters erase rectangles
7310
7311 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7312 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7313 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7314 drawing.
7315
7316 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7317 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7318 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7319 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7320
7321 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7322 can be turned off).
7323
7324 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7325 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7326 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7327 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7328 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7329 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7330 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7331 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7332 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7333
7334 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7335 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7336 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7337 on certain projects.
7338
7339 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7340 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7341
7342 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7343
7344 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7345 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7346 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7347 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7348 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7349 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7350 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7351 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7352
7353 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7354 Emacs is idle.
7355
7356 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7357 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7358
7359 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7360 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7361
7362 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7363 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7364 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7365 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7366 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7367
7368 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7369 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7370 separate Texinfo file.
7371
7372 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7373 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7374 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7375 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7376 enter check-in log messages.
7377
7378 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7379 without invoking external programs.
7380
7381 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7382 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7383 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7384 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7385 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7386
7387 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7388 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7389
7390 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7391 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7392
7393 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7394 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7395 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7396 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7397 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7398 single step.
7399
7400 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7401 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7402 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7403 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7404
7405 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7406 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7407 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7408
7409 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7410 PostScript.
7411
7412 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7413
7414 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7415
7416 ; comment (until end of line)
7417 A non-terminal
7418 "C" terminal
7419 ?C? special
7420 $A default non-terminal
7421 $"C" default terminal
7422 $?C? default special
7423 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7424 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7425 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7426 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7427 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7428 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7429 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7430 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7431 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7432 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7433 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7434 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7435 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7436 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7437 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7438
7439 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7440
7441 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7442 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7443 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7444 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7445 equal signs of assignments.
7446
7447 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7448 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7449
7450 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7451 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7452 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7453
7454 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7455
7456 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7457 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7458 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7459 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7460 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7461 which answers different needs.
7462
7463 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7464 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7465 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7466 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7467 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7468 to be enabled.
7469
7470 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7471 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7472
7473 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7474
7475 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7476 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7477 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7478
7479 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7480
7481 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7482 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7483 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7484 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7485 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7486 and background colors.
7487
7488 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7489 Pascal) language.
7490
7491 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7492 the text at point.
7493
7494 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7495
7496 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7497
7498 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7499 whitespace in a file.
7500
7501 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7502 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7503 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7504 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7505 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7506 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7507 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7508
7509 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7510
7511 Here is an example of columns:
7512
7513 horse apple bus
7514 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7515 porcupine strawberry airplane
7516
7517 Doing the following settings:
7518
7519 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7520 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7521 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7522 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7523
7524
7525 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7526
7527 M-x delimit-columns-region
7528
7529 It results:
7530
7531 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7532 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7533 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7534
7535 delim-col has the following options:
7536
7537 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7538 before all columns.
7539
7540 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7541 between each column.
7542
7543 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7544 after all columns.
7545
7546 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7547 each column.
7548
7549 delim-col has the following commands:
7550
7551 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7552 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7553
7554 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7555 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7556 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7557 recent file list can be displayed:
7558
7559 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7560 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7561 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7562
7563 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7564 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7565
7566 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7567 text.
7568
7569 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7570 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7571 specific to Message mode.
7572
7573 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7574 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7575 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7576
7577 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7578 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7579 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7580
7581 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7582 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7583
7584 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7585
7586 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7587 minibuffer with completion.
7588
7589 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7590 with the diary features.
7591
7592 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7593 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7594
7595 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7596 Fill mode.
7597
7598 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7599 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7600 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7601 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7602
7603 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7604 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7605 `.g'.
7606
7607 ** Changes in sort.el
7608
7609 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7610 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7611 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7612 numeric base.
7613
7614 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7615
7616 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7617 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7618 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7619
7620 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7621 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7622
7623 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7624 output ^M at the end of lines.
7625
7626 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7627 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7628
7629 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7630 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7631 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7632
7633 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7634 group.
7635
7636 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7637 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7638 are recognized:
7639
7640 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7641 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7642 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7643 nil -- just delete one character.
7644
7645 Default value is `untabify'.
7646
7647 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7648
7649 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7650 symbol, not double-quoted.
7651
7652 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7653 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7654 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7655 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7656
7657 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7658 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7659 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7660
7661 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7662 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7663 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7664
7665 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7666 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7667
7668 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7669 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7670
7671 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7672 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7673
7674 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7675 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7676 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7677 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7678 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7679 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7680
7681 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7682 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7683
7684 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7685
7686 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7687 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7688
7689 ** Shell script mode changes.
7690
7691 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7692 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7693 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7694
7695 ** Etags changes.
7696
7697 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7698
7699 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7700 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7701 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7702 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7703 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7704
7705 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7706 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7707
7708 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7709 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7710
7711 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7712 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7713 `template' keywords.
7714
7715 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7716 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7717
7718 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7719 types.
7720
7721 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7722
7723 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7724
7725 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7726 are now tagged.
7727
7728 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7729
7730 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7731 variables are tagged.
7732
7733 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7734
7735 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7736 for PSWrap.
7737
7738 ** Changes in etags.el
7739
7740 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7741 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7742 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7743
7744 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7745 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7746
7747 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7748 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7749 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7750 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7751
7752 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7753
7754 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7755 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7756
7757 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7758
7759 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7760 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7761 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7762
7763 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7764 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7765
7766 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7767 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7768
7769 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7770 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7771 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7772 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7773 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7774
7775 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7776 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7777 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7778
7779 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7780 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7781 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7782
7783 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7784 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7785 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7786
7787 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7788
7789 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7790
7791 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7792 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7793 expression from that list, are not checked.
7794
7795 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7796 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7797 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7798 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7799
7800 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7801
7802 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7803 displays local abbrevs, only.
7804
7805 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7806 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7807
7808 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7809 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7810 is measured in pixels.
7811
7812 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7813 to be visited as images.
7814
7815 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7816 were added to compile.el.
7817
7818 ** Withdrawn packages
7819
7820 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7821 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7822
7823 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7824
7825 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7826
7827 \f
7828 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7829
7830 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7831 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7832 See the sections below for details.
7833
7834 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7835 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7836 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7837 to remove the properties of the copy.
7838
7839 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7840 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7841 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7842 these properties are active.
7843
7844 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7845 ranges may affect some code.
7846
7847 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7848 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7849 make a difference to some code.
7850
7851 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7852 operates on the minibuffer.
7853
7854 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7855 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7856 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7857 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7858 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7859 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7860 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7861 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7862 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7863 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7864 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7865 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7866
7867 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7868 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7869 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7870
7871 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7872 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7873 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7874
7875 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7876 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7877 such as `mapconcat'.
7878
7879 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7880 string.
7881
7882 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7883 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7884 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7885 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7886 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7887 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7888 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7889 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7890
7891 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7892 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7893 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7894 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7895 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7896 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7897 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7898 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7899 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7900 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7901
7902 \f
7903 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7904 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7905
7906 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7907
7908 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7909 allows the animated display of strings.
7910
7911 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7912 interactive form of a function.
7913
7914 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7915 between custom options. Example:
7916
7917 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7918 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7919 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7920 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7921 :group 'mule
7922 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7923 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7924
7925 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7926 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7927 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7928
7929 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7930 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7931 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7932 (signal or normal termination).
7933
7934 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7935 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7936
7937 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7938 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7939
7940 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7941 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7942
7943 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7944
7945 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7946 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7947 being deleted.
7948
7949 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7950
7951 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7952 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7953 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7954 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7955 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7956 charset.
7957
7958 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7959 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7960 message.
7961
7962 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7963 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7964
7965 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7966 with the more general `:mask' property.
7967
7968 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7969
7970 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7971 backslash.
7972
7973 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7974 is running in batch mode. For example,
7975
7976 (message "%s" (read t))
7977
7978 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7979 to standard output.
7980
7981 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7982 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7983
7984 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7985 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7986 frame or window.
7987
7988 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7989 were added
7990
7991 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7992
7993 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7994 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7995
7996 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7997
7998 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7999 comparison is done with `eq'.
8000
8001 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
8002
8003 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
8004 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
8005 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
8006
8007 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
8008 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
8009 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
8010
8011 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
8012 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
8013
8014 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
8015 function was declared obsolete.
8016
8017 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
8018 retained as an alias).
8019
8020 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
8021 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
8022
8023 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
8024
8025 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
8026
8027 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
8028 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
8029 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
8030 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
8031 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
8032 means never include the minibuffer window.
8033
8034 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
8035
8036 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
8037
8038 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
8039
8040 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
8041 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
8042 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
8043 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
8044 returned.
8045
8046 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
8047 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
8048 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
8049 minibuffer even if it is active.
8050
8051 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
8052 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
8053 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
8054 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
8055 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
8056 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
8057
8058 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
8059 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
8060 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
8061 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
8062 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
8063 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
8064 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
8065
8066 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
8067 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
8068 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
8069
8070 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
8071 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
8072 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
8073 Default value is nil.
8074
8075 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
8076 meaning no limit.
8077
8078 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
8079 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
8080 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
8081
8082 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
8083 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
8084 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
8085
8086 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
8087 list of a primitive.
8088
8089 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
8090
8091 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
8092 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
8093 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
8094 than replacing the local map.
8095
8096 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
8097 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
8098 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
8099 instead.
8100
8101 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
8102
8103 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
8104 as promised long ago.
8105
8106 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
8107
8108 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
8109 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
8110 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
8111
8112 \f
8113 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
8114
8115 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
8116 regular expressions.
8117
8118 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
8119
8120 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8121
8122 - Macro: rx SEXP
8123
8124 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8125
8126 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
8127 notation.
8128
8129 STRING
8130 matches string STRING literally.
8131
8132 CHAR
8133 matches character CHAR literally.
8134
8135 `not-newline'
8136 matches any character except a newline.
8137 .
8138 `anything'
8139 matches any character
8140
8141 `(any SET)'
8142 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
8143 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
8144
8145 '(in SET)'
8146 like `any'.
8147
8148 `(not (any SET))'
8149 matches any character not in SET
8150
8151 `line-start'
8152 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
8153 in the text being matched
8154
8155 `line-end'
8156 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8157
8158 `string-start'
8159 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8160 string being matched against.
8161
8162 `string-end'
8163 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8164 string being matched against.
8165
8166 `buffer-start'
8167 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8168 buffer being matched against.
8169
8170 `buffer-end'
8171 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8172 buffer being matched against.
8173
8174 `point'
8175 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8176
8177 `word-start'
8178 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8179 word.
8180
8181 `word-end'
8182 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8183
8184 `word-boundary'
8185 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8186 word.
8187
8188 `(not word-boundary)'
8189 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8190 word.
8191
8192 `digit'
8193 matches 0 through 9.
8194
8195 `control'
8196 matches ASCII control characters.
8197
8198 `hex-digit'
8199 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8200
8201 `blank'
8202 matches space and tab only.
8203
8204 `graphic'
8205 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8206 space, and DEL.
8207
8208 `printing'
8209 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8210 and DEL.
8211
8212 `alphanumeric'
8213 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8214 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8215
8216 `letter'
8217 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8218 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8219
8220 `ascii'
8221 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8222
8223 `nonascii'
8224 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8225
8226 `lower'
8227 matches anything lower-case.
8228
8229 `upper'
8230 matches anything upper-case.
8231
8232 `punctuation'
8233 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8234 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8235
8236 `space'
8237 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8238
8239 `word'
8240 matches anything that has word syntax.
8241
8242 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8243 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8244 of the following symbols.
8245
8246 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8247 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8248 `word' (\\sw)
8249 `symbol' (\\s_)
8250 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8251 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8252 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8253 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8254 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8255 `escape' (\\s\\)
8256 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8257 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8258 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8259
8260 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8261 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8262
8263 `(category CATEGORY)'
8264 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8265 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8266
8267 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8268 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8269 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8270 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8271 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8272 `symbol' (\\c5)
8273 `digit' (\\c6)
8274 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8275 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8276 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8277 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8278 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8279 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8280 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8281 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8282 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8283 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8284 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8285 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8286 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8287 `ascii' (\\ca)
8288 `arabic' (\\cb)
8289 `chinese' (\\cc)
8290 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8291 `greek' (\\cg)
8292 `korean' (\\ch)
8293 `indian' (\\ci)
8294 `japanese' (\\cj)
8295 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8296 `latin' (\\cl)
8297 `lao' (\\co)
8298 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8299 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8300 `thai' (\\ct)
8301 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8302 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8303 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8304 `can-break' (\\c|)
8305
8306 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8307 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8308
8309 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8310 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8311
8312 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8313 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8314 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8315
8316 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8317 another name for `submatch'.
8318
8319 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8320 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8321 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8322 regular expression.
8323
8324 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8325 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8326 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8327 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8328 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8329
8330 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8331 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8332
8333 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8334 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8335
8336 `(0+ SEXP)'
8337 like `zero-or-more'.
8338
8339 `(* SEXP)'
8340 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8341
8342 `(*? SEXP)'
8343 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8344
8345 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8346 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8347
8348 `(1+ SEXP)'
8349 like `one-or-more'.
8350
8351 `(+ SEXP)'
8352 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8353
8354 `(+? SEXP)'
8355 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8356
8357 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8358 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8359
8360 `(optional SEXP)'
8361 like `zero-or-one'.
8362
8363 `(? SEXP)'
8364 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8365
8366 `(?? SEXP)'
8367 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8368
8369 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8370 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8371
8372 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8373 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8374
8375 `(eval FORM)'
8376 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8377 `regexp-quote' it.
8378
8379 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8380 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8381
8382 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8383
8384 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8385 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8386 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8387 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8388
8389 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8390 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8391 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8392 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8393
8394 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8395 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8396 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8397
8398 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8399 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8400 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8401 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8402 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8403 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8404 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8405 eight-bit-graphic.
8406
8407 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8408
8409 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8410 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8411 character set as previously.
8412
8413 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8414 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8415 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8416
8417 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8418 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8419 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8420 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8421
8422 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8423 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8424
8425 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8426 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8427 "fontset-default".
8428
8429 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8430 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8431
8432 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8433 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8434 buffers and strings.
8435
8436 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8437 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8438 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8439 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8440 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8441 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8442 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8443 also been deleted.
8444
8445 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8446 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8447 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8448
8449 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8450 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8451 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8452 may differ between buffer and string text.
8453
8454 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8455 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8456
8457 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8458 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8459 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8460 `composition' from STRING.
8461
8462 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8463 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8464
8465 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8466 obsolete.
8467
8468 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8469 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8470
8471 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8472 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8473 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8474 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8475
8476 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8477 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8478 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8479 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8480 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8481 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8482
8483 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8484 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8485 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8486
8487 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8488 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8489 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8490
8491 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8492 have been introduced.
8493
8494 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8495 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8496 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8497 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8498 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8499 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8500 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8501 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8502 their multibyte equivalent.
8503
8504 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8505 that offset in the file before writing.
8506
8507 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8508 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8509
8510 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8511 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8512 from which the command was issued.
8513
8514 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8515 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8516 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8517 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8518 operate on.
8519
8520 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8521 to `window-buffer-height'.
8522
8523 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8524
8525 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8526 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8527 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8528
8529 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8530 respectively.
8531
8532 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8533 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8534
8535 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8536 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8537 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8538
8539 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8540 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8541 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8542 is currently displayed in some window.
8543
8544 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8545 argument function's results.
8546
8547 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8548 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8549 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8550 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8551 sequence).
8552
8553 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8554 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8555
8556 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8557 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8558
8559 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8560 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8561 as follows:
8562
8563 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8564 nil don't display a cursor
8565 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8566 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8567 others display a box cursor.
8568
8569 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8570 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8571 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8572 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8573
8574 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8575 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8576 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8577 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8578
8579 Example:
8580
8581 (string-to-syntax "()")
8582 => (4 . 41)
8583
8584 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8585 other than 10.
8586
8587 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8588 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8589
8590 #b1111
8591 => 15
8592 #b-1111
8593 => -15
8594
8595 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8596
8597 #o666
8598 => 438
8599
8600 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8601
8602 #xbeef
8603 => 48815
8604
8605 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8606
8607 #2R-111
8608 => -7
8609 #25rah
8610 => 267
8611
8612 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8613 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8614 and isn't a string.
8615
8616 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8617 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8618 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8619 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8620
8621 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8622
8623 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8624 for a regexp in a string.
8625
8626 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8627 `mouse-position-function'.
8628
8629 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8630 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8631
8632 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8633 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8634
8635 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8636 returns it.
8637
8638 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8639 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8640
8641 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8642 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8643 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8644 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8645 mode.
8646
8647 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8648 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8649
8650 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8651 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8652 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8653 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8654 been performed."
8655
8656 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8657 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8658 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8659 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8660
8661 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8662 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8663 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8664
8665 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8666 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8667 specified table.
8668
8669 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8670
8671 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8672 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8673 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8674 what BODY returns.
8675
8676 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8677 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8678 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8679 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8680 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8681
8682 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8683 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8684
8685 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8686 instead of being optional.
8687
8688 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8689 modify read-only text.
8690
8691 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8692
8693 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8694 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8695 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8696 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8697 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8698
8699 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8700 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8701 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8702 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8703 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8704 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8705 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8706
8707 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8708 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8709 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8710 start sequences.
8711
8712 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8713 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8714
8715 ** New function `propertize'
8716
8717 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8718 strings with text properties.
8719
8720 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8721
8722 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8723 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8724 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8725 specified value of that property. Example:
8726
8727 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8728
8729 ** push and pop macros.
8730
8731 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8732 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8733 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8734
8735 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8736 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8737 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8738
8739 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8740
8741 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8742 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8743
8744 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8745 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8746 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8747 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8748
8749 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8750 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8751 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8752 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8753
8754 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8755 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8756 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8757 or a sign.
8758
8759 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8760 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8761 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8762 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8763 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8764 space, and DEL.
8765 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8766 and DEL.
8767 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8768 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8769 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8770 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8771 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8772 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8773 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8774 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8775 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8776 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8777 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8778 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8779 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8780 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8781 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8782
8783 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8784
8785 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8786
8787 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8788
8789 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8790 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8791
8792 :test TEST
8793
8794 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8795 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8796 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8797
8798 :size SIZE
8799
8800 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8801 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8802
8803 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8804
8805 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8806 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8807 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8808 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8809 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8810
8811 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8812
8813 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8814 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8815 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8816
8817 :weakness WEAK
8818
8819 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8820 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8821 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8822 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8823 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8824
8825 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8826
8827 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8828
8829 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8830
8831 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8832
8833 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8834
8835 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8836 values are shared.
8837
8838 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8839
8840 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8841
8842 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8843
8844 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8845
8846 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8847
8848 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8849
8850 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8851
8852 Returns the size of TABLE.
8853
8854 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8855
8856 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8857
8858 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8859
8860 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8861
8862 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8863
8864 Clear TABLE.
8865
8866 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8867
8868 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8869 not found.
8870
8871 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8872
8873 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8874 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8875
8876 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8877
8878 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8879
8880 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8881
8882 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8883 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8884
8885 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8886
8887 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8888
8889 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8890
8891 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8892 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8893 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8894 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8895 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8896
8897 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8898
8899 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8900 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8901 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8902
8903 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8904 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8905
8906 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8907 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8908
8909 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8910 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8911
8912 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8913 'case-fold-string-hash))
8914
8915 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8916
8917 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8918
8919 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8920 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8921 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8922
8923 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8924
8925 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8926 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8927
8928 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8929 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8930 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8931 is too short to reach that column.
8932
8933 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8934 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8935 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8936 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8937
8938 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8939 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8940 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8941
8942 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8943 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8944
8945 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8946 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8947
8948 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8949 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8950 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8951 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8952 temporary-file-directory instead.
8953
8954 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8955 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8956 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8957 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8958
8959 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8960 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8961
8962 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8963
8964 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8965 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8966 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8967
8968 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8969
8970 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8971 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8972 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8973 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8974 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8975 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8976
8977 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8978 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8979 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8980 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8981
8982 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8983
8984 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8985 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8986 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8987 result string.
8988
8989 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8990 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8991
8992 Example:
8993
8994 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8995 (s2 "world"))
8996 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8997 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8998 (format s1 s2))
8999
9000 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
9001
9002 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
9003
9004 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
9005 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
9006 argument in it.
9007
9008 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
9009 (arg "world"))
9010 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
9011 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
9012 (message msg arg))
9013
9014 ** Sound support
9015
9016 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
9017 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
9018
9019 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
9020 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
9021 to enable sound support.
9022
9023 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
9024 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
9025 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
9026 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
9027 sound to play, before playing the sound.
9028
9029 The following sound properties are supported:
9030
9031 - `:file FILE'
9032
9033 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
9034 searched relative to `data-directory'.
9035
9036 - `:data DATA'
9037
9038 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
9039 may be present, but not both.
9040
9041 - `:volume VOLUME'
9042
9043 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
9044 0..1. This property is optional.
9045
9046 - `:device DEVICE'
9047
9048 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
9049 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
9050
9051 Other properties are ignored.
9052
9053 An alternative interface is called as
9054 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
9055
9056 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
9057
9058 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
9059 a keyword symbol.
9060
9061 ** Changes to garbage collection
9062
9063 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
9064 of live and free strings.
9065
9066 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
9067 strings that have been consed so far.
9068
9069 \f
9070 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
9071 Lisp Manual
9072
9073 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
9074 mini-windows.
9075
9076 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
9077 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
9078 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
9079
9080 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
9081
9082 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
9083
9084 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
9085 image.
9086
9087 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
9088
9089 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
9090
9091 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
9092 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
9093 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
9094 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
9095 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
9096
9097 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
9098 has a mask bitmap.
9099
9100 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
9101
9102 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
9103 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
9104 or omitted means use the selected frame.
9105
9106 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
9107 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
9108
9109 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
9110 optional.
9111
9112 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
9113 below).
9114
9115 \f
9116 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
9117
9118 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
9119 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
9120
9121 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
9122 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
9123 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
9124 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
9125 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
9126 just display it black instead.
9127
9128 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
9129 a line like
9130
9131 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
9132
9133 in your `.emacs'.
9134
9135 ** New face implementation.
9136
9137 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
9138 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
9139
9140 *** New faces.
9141
9142 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
9143
9144 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
9145
9146 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
9147 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
9148
9149 3. Font height in 1/10pt
9150
9151 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
9152
9153 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9154
9155 6. Foreground color.
9156
9157 7. Background color.
9158
9159 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9160
9161 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9162
9163 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9164
9165 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9166
9167 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9168 color.
9169
9170 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9171 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9172
9173 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9174 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9175 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9176 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9177 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9178 attributes mentioned above.
9179
9180 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9181 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9182 created frames.
9183
9184 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9185 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9186 `fully-specified'.
9187
9188 *** Face merging.
9189
9190 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9191 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9192 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9193 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9194 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9195 results in a fully-specified face.
9196
9197 *** Face realization.
9198
9199 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9200 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9201 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9202 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9203 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9204 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9205
9206 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9207 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9208 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9209 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9210
9211 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9212 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9213 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9214 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9215 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9216
9217 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9218 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9219 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9220 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9221 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9222 Emacs.
9223
9224 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9225 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9226 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9227 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9228
9229 **** Clearing face caches.
9230
9231 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9232 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9233 unused fonts.
9234
9235 *** Font selection.
9236
9237 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9238 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9239 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9240
9241 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9242 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9243 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9244 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9245 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9246
9247 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9248 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9249 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9250
9251 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9252
9253 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9254 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9255 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9256 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9257 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9258 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9259 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9260
9261 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9262 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9263 doesn't exist.
9264
9265 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9266 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9267 registry.
9268
9269 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9270 slightly different.
9271
9272 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9273
9274
9275 **** Scalable fonts
9276
9277 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9278 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9279 servers.
9280
9281 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9282 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9283 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9284 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9285 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9286 that list. Example:
9287
9288 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9289
9290 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9291
9292 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9293
9294 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9295
9296 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9297 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9298 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9299
9300 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9301 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9302 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9303 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9304 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9305 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9306 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9307 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9308 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9309 of the face font sort order.
9310
9311 - Function: x-font-family-list
9312
9313 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9314 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9315 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9316 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9317
9318 - Variable: font-list-limit
9319
9320 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9321 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9322 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9323
9324 *** Setting face attributes.
9325
9326 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9327 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9328 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9329 `face-attribute'.
9330
9331 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9332 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9333
9334 The following attributes are recognized:
9335
9336 `:family'
9337
9338 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9339 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9340 and `?' are allowed.
9341
9342 `:width'
9343
9344 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9345 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9346 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9347 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9348
9349 `:height'
9350
9351 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9352 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9353 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9354 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9355
9356 `:weight'
9357
9358 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9359 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9360 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9361
9362 `:slant'
9363
9364 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9365 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9366 `reverse-oblique'.
9367
9368 `:foreground', `:background'
9369
9370 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9371
9372 `:underline'
9373
9374 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9375 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9376 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9377 don't underline.
9378
9379 `:overline'
9380
9381 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9382 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9383 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9384 overline.
9385
9386 `:strike-through'
9387
9388 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9389 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9390 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9391 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9392
9393 `:box'
9394
9395 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9396 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9397 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9398 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9399 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9400 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9401 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9402 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9403 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9404 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9405 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9406 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9407 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9408 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9409 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9410 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9411 box.
9412
9413 `:inverse-video'
9414
9415 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9416 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9417
9418 `:stipple'
9419
9420 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9421 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9422 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9423 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9424 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9425 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9426
9427 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9428 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9429
9430 `:font'
9431
9432 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9433 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9434 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9435 versions of Emacs.
9436
9437 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9438 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9439 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9440
9441 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9442 `defface'.
9443
9444 `:inherit'
9445
9446 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9447 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9448 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9449
9450 *** Face attributes and X resources
9451
9452 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9453 from X resources:
9454
9455 Face attribute X resource class
9456 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9457 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9458 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9459 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9460 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9461 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9462 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9463 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9464 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9465 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9466 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9467 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9468 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9469 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9470 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9471 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9472 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9473 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9474 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9475 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9476
9477 *** Text property `face'.
9478
9479 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9480 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9481 specification can be
9482
9483 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9484
9485 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9486 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9487 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9488 for face attribute names.
9489
9490 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9491 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9492 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9493
9494 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9495
9496 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9497 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9498 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9499 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9500 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9501 used to clear the mapping table.
9502
9503 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9504
9505 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9506 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9507 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9508 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9509 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9510 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9511 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9512 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9513 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9514 modify their color-related behavior.
9515
9516 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9517 any frame type.
9518
9519 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9520
9521 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9522 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9523 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9524 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9525 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9526 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9527 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9528 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9529 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9530
9531 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9532 display can display image files.
9533
9534 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9535
9536 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9537 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9538 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9539 `Inviolable' option.
9540
9541 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9542 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9543 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9544
9545 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9546
9547 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9548 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9549 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9550
9551 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9552 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9553 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9554 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9555 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9556 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9557 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9558 functions.
9559
9560 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9561 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9562 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9563
9564 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9565
9566 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9567
9568 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9569
9570 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9571 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9572 constrained position if that is different.
9573
9574 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9575 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9576 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9577 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9578 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9579 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9580 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9581 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9582 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9583
9584 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9585 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9586 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9587 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9588 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9589
9590 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9591 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9592
9593 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9594
9595 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9596
9597 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9598 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9599 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9600
9601 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9602
9603 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9604 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9605 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9606 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9607 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9608
9609 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9610
9611 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9612 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9613 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9614 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9615 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9616
9617 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9618
9619 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9620 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9621 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9622
9623 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9624
9625 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9626 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9627 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9628
9629 ** Image support.
9630
9631 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9632 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9633 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9634 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9635
9636 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9637 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9638 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9639 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9640 area.
9641
9642 IMAGE is an image specification.
9643
9644 *** Image specifications
9645
9646 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9647 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9648 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9649 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9650 described below are ignored.
9651
9652 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9653
9654 `:ascent ASCENT'
9655
9656 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9657 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9658 to use for its ascent.
9659
9660 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9661 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9662
9663 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9664 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9665 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9666 overlays that apply to the image.
9667
9668 `:margin MARGIN'
9669
9670 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9671 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9672 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9673
9674 `:relief RELIEF'
9675
9676 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9677 around an image.
9678
9679 `:conversion ALGO'
9680
9681 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9682
9683 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9684 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9685
9686 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9687 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9688 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9689 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9690 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9691 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9692 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9693 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9694 below.
9695
9696 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9697 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9698 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9699
9700 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9701 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9702 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9703 of the factors' absolute values.
9704
9705 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9706
9707 (1 0 0
9708 0 0 0
9709 9 9 -1)
9710
9711 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9712
9713 ( 2 -1 0
9714 -1 0 1
9715 0 1 -2)
9716
9717 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9718 ``disabled''.
9719
9720 `:mask MASK'
9721
9722 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9723 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9724 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9725 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9726 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9727 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9728 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9729 image.
9730
9731 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9732 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9733 `:mask nil'.
9734
9735 `:file FILE'
9736
9737 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9738 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9739 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9740 may be present in the image specification.
9741
9742 `:data DATA'
9743
9744 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9745 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9746 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9747 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9748
9749 *** Supported image types
9750
9751 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9752
9753 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9754 properties supported are:
9755
9756 `:foreground FG'
9757
9758 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9759 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9760
9761 `:background BG'
9762
9763 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9764 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9765
9766 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9767 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9768 instead of a `:file' property.
9769
9770 `:width WIDTH'
9771
9772 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9773
9774 `:height HEIGHT'
9775
9776 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9777
9778 `:data DATA'
9779
9780 DATA must be either
9781
9782 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9783 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9784
9785 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9786
9787 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9788 bitmap.
9789
9790 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9791 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9792 in the file.
9793
9794 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9795
9796 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9797 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9798 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9799 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9800
9801 Additional image properties supported are:
9802
9803 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9804
9805 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9806 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9807 name.
9808
9809 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9810 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9811
9812 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9813 to display compressed images.
9814
9815 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9816
9817 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9818 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9819 mono images are:
9820
9821 `:foreground FG'
9822
9823 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9824 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9825
9826 `:background FG'
9827
9828 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9829 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9830
9831 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9832
9833 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9834 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9835 properties defined.
9836
9837 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9838
9839 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9840 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9841 properties defined.
9842
9843 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9844
9845 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9846 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9847
9848 Additional image properties supported are:
9849
9850 `:index INDEX'
9851
9852 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9853 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9854 as a hollow box.
9855
9856 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9857 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9858 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9859 every 0.1 seconds.
9860
9861 (defun show-anim (file max)
9862 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9863 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9864
9865 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9866 (when (= idx max)
9867 (setq idx 0))
9868 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9869 (save-excursion
9870 (set-buffer buffer)
9871 (goto-char (point-min))
9872 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9873 (insert-image img "x"))
9874 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9875
9876 **** PNG, image type `png'
9877
9878 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9879 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9880 properties defined.
9881
9882 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9883
9884 Additional image properties supported are:
9885
9886 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9887
9888 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9889 integer. This is a required property.
9890
9891 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9892
9893 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9894 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9895
9896 `:bounding-box BOX'
9897
9898 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9899 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9900 files. This is an required property.
9901
9902 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9903 lisp/gs.el.
9904
9905 *** Lisp interface.
9906
9907 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9908 which are supported in the current configuration.
9909
9910 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9911 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9912 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9913 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9914 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9915
9916 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9917
9918 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9919 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9920 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9921 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9922 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9923 buffer.
9924
9925 ** Display margins.
9926
9927 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9928 and images.
9929
9930 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9931 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9932 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9933 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9934 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9935 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9936 of the display margins.
9937
9938 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9939 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9940 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9941 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9942 in this file).
9943
9944 ** Help display
9945
9946 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9947 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9948 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9949 that have a `help-echo' property.
9950
9951 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9952 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9953 the window in which the help was found.
9954
9955 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9956 `help-echo' text property was found.
9957
9958 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9959 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9960
9961 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9962 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9963 mouse.
9964
9965 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9966 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9967
9968 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9969 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9970 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9971 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9972 used as help string.
9973
9974 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9975 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9976 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9977
9978 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9979
9980 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9981 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9982
9983 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9984 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9985 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9986 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9987 used.
9988
9989 (global-set-key [A-down]
9990 #'(lambda ()
9991 (interactive)
9992 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9993 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9994 (global-set-key [A-up]
9995 #'(lambda ()
9996 (interactive)
9997 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9998 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9999
10000 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
10001
10002 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
10003 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
10004 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
10005 is called with one argument, POS.
10006
10007 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
10008 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
10009 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
10010 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
10011 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
10012
10013 ** Tool bar support.
10014
10015 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
10016 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
10017 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
10018 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
10019 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
10020 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
10021
10022 *** Tool bar item definitions
10023
10024 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
10025 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
10026 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
10027
10028 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
10029 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
10030 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
10031 property (see below).
10032
10033 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
10034 binding are currently ignored.
10035
10036 The following properties are recognized:
10037
10038 `:enable FORM'.
10039
10040 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
10041 or disabled.
10042
10043 `:visible FORM'
10044
10045 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
10046
10047 `:filter FUNCTION'
10048
10049 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
10050 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
10051 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
10052
10053 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
10054
10055 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
10056 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
10057
10058 `:image IMAGES'
10059
10060 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
10061 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
10062 meaning of each of the four elements:
10063
10064 Index Use when item is
10065 ----------------------------------------
10066 0 enabled and selected
10067 1 enabled and deselected
10068 2 disabled and selected
10069 3 disabled and deselected
10070
10071 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
10072 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
10073
10074 `:help HELP-STRING'.
10075
10076 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
10077 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
10078
10079 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
10080 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
10081 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
10082 menu bar.
10083
10084 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
10085 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
10086 buffer-locally to override the global map.
10087
10088 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
10089
10090 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
10091 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
10092 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
10093
10094 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
10095 raised when the mouse moves over them.
10096
10097 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
10098 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
10099 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
10100 vertical margins . Default is 1.
10101
10102 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
10103 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
10104
10105 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
10106
10107 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
10108 a tool bar item. If
10109
10110 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
10111 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
10112 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
10113
10114 is the original tool bar item definition, then
10115
10116 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
10117
10118 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
10119 item.
10120
10121 ** Mode line changes.
10122
10123 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
10124
10125 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
10126 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
10127 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
10128
10129 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
10130 a `local-map' text property.
10131
10132 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
10133 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
10134
10135 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
10136 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
10137 `local-map' property.
10138
10139 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
10140 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
10141 example.
10142
10143 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
10144 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
10145
10146 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
10147 variable mode-line-format to nil.
10148
10149 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
10150
10151 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
10152 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
10153 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10154 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10155 line.
10156
10157 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10158 `header-line'.
10159
10160 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10161 position in the header-line.
10162
10163 ** Text property `display'
10164
10165 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10166 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10167 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10168 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10169 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10170
10171 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10172
10173 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10174 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10175
10176 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10177 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10178 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10179 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10180 simpler form STRING as property value.
10181
10182 *** Variable width and height spaces
10183
10184 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10185 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10186 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10187 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10188 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10189 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10190 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10191
10192 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10193 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10194 properties described below.
10195
10196 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10197 characters having the `display' property.
10198
10199 - :width WIDTH
10200
10201 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10202 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10203
10204 - :relative-width FACTOR
10205
10206 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10207 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10208 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10209 width of that character by FACTOR.
10210
10211 - :align-to HPOS
10212
10213 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10214 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10215
10216 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10217
10218 - :height HEIGHT
10219
10220 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10221 normal line height.
10222
10223 - :relative-height FACTOR
10224
10225 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10226 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10227
10228 - :ascent ASCENT
10229
10230 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10231 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10232 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10233 equal to 100.
10234
10235 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10236
10237 *** Images
10238
10239 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10240 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10241 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10242 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10243 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10244 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10245 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10246 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10247 as display specification.
10248
10249 *** Other display properties
10250
10251 - (space-width FACTOR)
10252
10253 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10254 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10255 integer or float.
10256
10257 - (height HEIGHT)
10258
10259 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10260
10261 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10262 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10263 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10264 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10265 a font is available counts as a step.
10266
10267 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10268 as tall as the frame's default font.
10269
10270 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10271 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10272
10273 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10274 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10275
10276 - (raise FACTOR)
10277
10278 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10279 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10280 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10281 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10282 `height' subproperty.
10283
10284 *** Conditional display properties
10285
10286 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10287 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10288 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10289 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10290 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10291 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10292 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10293 different when object is a string.
10294
10295 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10296 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10297
10298 ** New menu separator types.
10299
10300 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10301 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10302 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10303 to specify other menu separator types.
10304
10305 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10306
10307 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10308 separator occurs.
10309
10310 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10311
10312 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10313
10314 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10315
10316 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10317
10318 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10319
10320 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10321
10322 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10323
10324 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10325
10326 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10327
10328 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10329 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10330
10331 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10332
10333 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10334
10335 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10336
10337 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10338
10339 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10340
10341 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10342
10343 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10344
10345 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10346
10347 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10348
10349 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10350
10351 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10352
10353 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10354
10355 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10356
10357 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10358
10359 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10360 the corresponding single-line separators.
10361
10362 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10363
10364 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10365 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10366 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10367 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10368 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10369 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10370 default foreground is black.
10371
10372 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10373 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10374 `ScrollBarBackground').
10375
10376 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10377 settings for scroll bar colors.
10378
10379 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10380 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10381
10382 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10383 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10384 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10385 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10386 the original window start.
10387
10388 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10389 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10390 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10391
10392 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10393
10394 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10395 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10396 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10397 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10398
10399 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10400 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10401
10402 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10403
10404 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10405 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10406 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10407 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10408 temporarily to nil, for example
10409
10410 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10411 (enlarge-window 10))
10412
10413 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10414 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10415
10416 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10417 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10418 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10419 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10420 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10421 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10422
10423
10424 \f
10425 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10426
10427 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10428 input.
10429
10430 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10431
10432 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10433
10434 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10435 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10436 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10437 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10438 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10439
10440 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10441 been added.
10442
10443 \f
10444 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10445
10446 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10447
10448
10449 \f
10450 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10451
10452 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10453 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10454 \f
10455 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10456
10457 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10458
10459 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10460 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10461 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10462
10463 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10464 is the one that is used.
10465
10466 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10467 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10468 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10469 separate from the command's regular output.
10470 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10471 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10472 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10473 the buffer name.
10474
10475 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10476 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10477 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10478 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10479
10480 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10481 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10482 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10483 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10484
10485 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10486 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10487 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10488 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10489
10490 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10491 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10492 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10493 they never ignore case.
10494
10495 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10496 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10497 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10498 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10499 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10500 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10501 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10502
10503 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10504 the same format that was used in the file before.
10505
10506 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10507 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10508
10509 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10510 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10511 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10512
10513 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10514 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10515 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10516 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10517 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10518 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10519 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10520
10521 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10522 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10523 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10524 format. You can now customize these variables.
10525
10526 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10527 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10528 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10529 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10530
10531 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10532 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10533 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10534
10535 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10536 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10537 doesn't have any effect.
10538
10539 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10540 not one per buffer.
10541
10542 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10543 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10544 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10545
10546 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10547 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10548 `auto-show-mode' command.
10549
10550 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10551 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10552 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10553 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10554 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10555
10556 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10557 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10558
10559 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10560 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10561 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10562
10563 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10564 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10565 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10566 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10567
10568 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10569
10570 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10571 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10572 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10573 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10574 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10575
10576 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10577 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10578
10579 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10580 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10581 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10582 `?' on other systems.
10583
10584 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10585 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10586 Unix.
10587
10588 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10589 current codepage when it starts.
10590
10591 ** Mail changes
10592
10593 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10594 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10595 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10596 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10597 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10598 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10599 latin-1:
10600
10601 MIME-version: 1.0
10602 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10603 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10604
10605 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10606 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10607 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10608 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10609 buffer-file-coding-system.
10610
10611 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10612 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10613 mail.
10614
10615 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10616 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10617 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10618 list of possible coding systems.
10619
10620 ** CC Mode changes
10621
10622 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10623 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10624 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10625 docstring for details.
10626
10627 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10628 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10629 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10630 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10631 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10632
10633 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10634 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10635
10636 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10637 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10638
10639 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10640 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10641 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10642 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10643 anonymous classes.
10644
10645 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10646 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10647
10648 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10649 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10650 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10651 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10652
10653 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10654 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10655 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10656 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10657 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10658
10659 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10660
10661 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10662
10663 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10664 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10665
10666 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10667
10668 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10669 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10670 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10671 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10672 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10673
10674 ** Gnus changes.
10675
10676 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10677 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10678 Gnus manual for the full story.
10679
10680 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10681 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10682 group, which is created automatically.
10683
10684 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10685 values.
10686
10687 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10688
10689 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10690 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10691
10692 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10693 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10694
10695 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10696
10697 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10698 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10699
10700 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10701
10702 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10703 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10704
10705 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10706 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10707
10708 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10709 control over simplification.
10710
10711 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10712
10713 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10714 limit.
10715
10716 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10717
10718 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10719
10720 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10721 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10722 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10723
10724 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10725 `a' forces normal posting method.
10726
10727 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10728 -- `W d'.
10729
10730 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10731 to a non-nil value.
10732
10733 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10734 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10735
10736 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10737 has been added.
10738
10739 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10740
10741 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10742
10743 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10744 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10745
10746 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10747 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10748
10749 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10750
10751 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10752 been added.
10753
10754 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10755 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10756
10757 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10758 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10759
10760 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10761
10762 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10763
10764 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10765
10766 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10767
10768 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10769 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10770 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10771
10772 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10773 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10774 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10775 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10776 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10777
10778 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10779 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10780 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10781 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10782
10783 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10784 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10785 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10786 mismatch.
10787
10788 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10789
10790 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10791 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10792
10793 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10794 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10795 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10796 removed from the label.
10797
10798 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10799 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10800
10801 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10802 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10803
10804 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10805 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10806 expressions.
10807
10808 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10809
10810 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10811
10812 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10813 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10814
10815 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10816 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10817 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10818
10819 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10820 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10821 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10822 \f
10823 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10824
10825 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10826 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10827 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10828 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10829 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10830
10831 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10832 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10833 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10834
10835 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10836 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10837 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10838 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10839 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10840 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10841 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10842 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10843 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10844
10845 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10846 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10847 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10848 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10849 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10850 program.
10851
10852 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10853 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10854 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10855 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10856 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10857 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10858
10859 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10860 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10861 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10862 was not documented clearly before.
10863
10864 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10865 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10866 \f
10867 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10868
10869 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10870 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10871 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10872 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10873
10874 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10875 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10876 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10877
10878 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10879
10880 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10881 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10882
10883 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10884 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10885 integers.
10886
10887 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10888 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10889 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10890 file names and attributes are returned.
10891
10892 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10893 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10894 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10895 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10896 returns the result.
10897
10898 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10899 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10900
10901 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10902
10903 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10904 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10905 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10906 optionally.
10907
10908 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10909 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10910
10911 **
10912 The new function process-running-child-p
10913 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10914 terminal to its own child process.
10915
10916 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10917 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10918 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10919 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10920
10921 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10922 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10923
10924 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10925 :included is an alias for :visible.
10926
10927 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10928 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10929 to move or copy menu entries.
10930
10931 ** Multibyte editing changes
10932
10933 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10934 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10935 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10936 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10937 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10938 (setq char (sref str idx)
10939 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10940 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10941
10942 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10943 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10944 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10945
10946 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10947 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10948 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10949
10950 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10951
10952 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10953 across the boundary.
10954
10955 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10956 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10957 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10958 contains 8-bit characters.
10959 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10960 contains invalid characters.
10961
10962 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10963 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10964 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10965 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10966 way.
10967
10968 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10969 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10970 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10971 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10972
10973 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10974 compose Thai characters in a string.
10975
10976 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10977 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10978 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10979 menus should always use the third argument.
10980
10981 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10982 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10983 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10984 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10985
10986 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10987 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10988 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10989 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10990
10991 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10992 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10993 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10994 echo area contents.
10995
10996 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10997
10998 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10999 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
11000 requested feature cannot be loaded.
11001
11002 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
11003 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
11004 means to clear out that attribute.
11005
11006 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
11007 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
11008
11009 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
11010 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
11011 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
11012 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
11013
11014 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
11015 the gap of the current buffer.
11016
11017 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
11018 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
11019 current buffer.
11020
11021 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
11022 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
11023 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
11024 it back in after any modifications have been made.
11025 \f
11026 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
11027
11028 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
11029 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
11030 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
11031 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
11032 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
11033
11034 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
11035 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
11036 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
11037 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
11038 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
11039
11040 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
11041 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
11042 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
11043
11044 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
11045 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
11046 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
11047 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
11048 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
11049 results.
11050
11051 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
11052 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
11053 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
11054 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
11055 \f
11056 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
11057
11058 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
11059 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
11060 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
11061 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
11062
11063 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
11064 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
11065 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
11066 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
11067 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
11068 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
11069 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
11070 region.
11071
11072 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
11073 selective undo.
11074
11075 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
11076 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
11077 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
11078 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
11079 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
11080
11081 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
11082 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
11083 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
11084 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
11085
11086 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
11087 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
11088 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
11089 something that most users not do.
11090
11091 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
11092 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
11093 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
11094 applications.
11095
11096 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
11097 pasting operations.
11098
11099 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
11100 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
11101 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
11102 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
11103 `ps-printer-name'.
11104
11105 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
11106 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
11107 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
11108 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
11109 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
11110 hits a new word.
11111
11112 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
11113 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
11114 to be confused by TeX commands.
11115
11116 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
11117 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
11118 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
11119 of various alternative replacements and actions.
11120
11121 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
11122 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
11123 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
11124 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
11125 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
11126
11127 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
11128 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
11129
11130 ** Changes in input method usage.
11131
11132 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
11133 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
11134 respectively.
11135
11136 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
11137
11138 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
11139 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
11140
11141 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
11142 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
11143
11144 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
11145
11146 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
11147
11148 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
11149 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
11150
11151 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11152 given in the following case:
11153 o When you are using a complex input method.
11154 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11155
11156 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11157 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11158 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11159 setting it to t is helpful.
11160
11161 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11162
11163 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11164 keys:
11165 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11166 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11167 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11168 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11169 environment.
11170
11171 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11172 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11173 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11174 get
11175
11176 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11177
11178 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11179
11180 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11181 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11182
11183 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11184 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11185 its owner and group.
11186
11187 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11188 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11189
11190 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11191 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11192
11193 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11194 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11195 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11196 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11197
11198 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11199 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11200 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11201 for writing keyboard macros.
11202
11203 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11204 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11205 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11206 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11207 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11208 info.
11209
11210 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11211
11212 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11213 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11214 contents only.
11215
11216 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11217 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11218 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11219 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11220
11221 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11222 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11223 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11224
11225 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11226 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11227 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11228 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11229
11230 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11231 failure if the command produces no output.
11232
11233 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11234 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11235 the mouse.
11236
11237 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11238 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11239 function and variable names.
11240
11241 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11242 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11243 file-coding-system-alist.
11244
11245 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11246 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11247 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11248 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11249 according to the current fontset.
11250
11251 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11252
11253 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11254 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11255 nonascii-insert-offset.
11256
11257 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11258 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11259 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11260 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11261
11262 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11263 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11264
11265 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11266 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11267
11268 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11269 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11270 command keys.
11271
11272 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11273 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11274
11275 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11276 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11277 all variables that have documentation.
11278
11279 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11280 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11281 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11282 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11283 it should show; the default is 20.
11284
11285 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11286 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11287 of your input.
11288
11289 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11290 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11291 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11292 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11293 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11294 Newly added options are included as well.
11295
11296 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11297 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11298 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11299
11300 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11301 Customize menu.
11302
11303 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11304 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11305
11306 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11307 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11308 invoked.
11309
11310 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11311 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11312 The default is 1.
11313
11314 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11315 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11316 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11317 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11318 sensibly.
11319
11320 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11321
11322 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11323 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11324 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11325
11326 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11327 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11328 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11329 every night.
11330
11331 ** Desktop changes
11332
11333 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11334 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11335
11336 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11337 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11338
11339 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11340 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11341
11342 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11343 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11344 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11345 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11346 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11347 made invisible again.
11348
11349 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11350
11351 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11352 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11353 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11354 toggle.
11355
11356 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11357 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11358 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11359 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11360 rmail-default-body-file.
11361
11362 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11363 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11364 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11365
11366 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11367 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11368 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11369
11370 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11371 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11372 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11373 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11374 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11375 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11376
11377 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11378 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11379 provided by feedmail are:
11380
11381 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11382 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11383 there is also a queue for draft messages
11384
11385 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11386 be prompted for confirmation
11387
11388 **** does smart filling of address headers
11389
11390 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11391 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11392 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11393
11394 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11395 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11396 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11397 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11398
11399 ** Dired changes
11400
11401 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11402 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11403
11404 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11405 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11406
11407 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11408 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11409 for a specified regexp.
11410
11411 ** VC Changes
11412
11413 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11414 conveniently.
11415
11416 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11417 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11418 Dired.
11419
11420 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11421 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11422 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11423 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11424
11425 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11426 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11427 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11428 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11429 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11430
11431 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11432 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11433 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11434 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11435 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11436
11437 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11438 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11439 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11440 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11441
11442 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11443 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11444 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11445
11446 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11447 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11448 session to resolve them.
11449
11450 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11451 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11452 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11453 uses as well).
11454
11455 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11456 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11457 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11458 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11459 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11460 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11461 using ediff.
11462
11463 ** Changes in Font Lock
11464
11465 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11466 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11467 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11468 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11469 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11470
11471 ** Frame name display changes
11472
11473 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11474 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11475 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11476 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11477
11478 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11479 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11480 menu.
11481
11482 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11483
11484 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11485 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11486 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11487
11488 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11489
11490 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11491 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11492 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11493
11494 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11495 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11496 the following line.
11497
11498 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11499 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11500 previously sent input.
11501
11502 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11503 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11504 as the search string.
11505
11506 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11507 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11508
11509 ** C mode changes
11510
11511 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11512 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11513 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11514 definition.
11515
11516 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11517 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11518 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11519 style is still the default however.
11520
11521 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11522
11523 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11524 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11525 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11526
11527 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11528 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11529
11530 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11531 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11532
11533 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11534 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11535
11536 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11537 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11538
11539 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11540 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11541 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11542 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11543
11544 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11545
11546 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11547 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11548 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11549
11550 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11551 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11552 expanding dynamically.
11553
11554 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11555 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11556
11557 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11558 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11559 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11560 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11561
11562 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11563
11564 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11565
11566 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11567 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11568 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11569 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11570 against the first word in the title.
11571
11572 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11573 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11574 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11575 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11576 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11577 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11578
11579 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11580 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11581 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11582 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11583
11584 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11585
11586 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11587 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11588 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11589 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11590 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11591 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11592
11593 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11594 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11595
11596 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11597 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11598 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11599
11600 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11601 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11602
11603 ** Ispell changes.
11604
11605 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11606 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11607 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11608
11609 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11610 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11611 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11612 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11613 include:
11614
11615 o URLs are automatically skipped
11616 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11617
11618 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11619
11620 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11621
11622 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11623 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11624 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11625 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11626
11627 *** New recursive parser.
11628
11629 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11630 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11631 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11632
11633 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11634
11635 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11636 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11637 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11638
11639 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11640
11641 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11642
11643 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11644
11645 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11646
11647 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11648
11649 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11650 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11651
11652 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11653
11654 *** References to external documents.
11655
11656 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11657 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11658 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11659 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11660 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11661 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11662 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11663
11664 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11665
11666 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11667 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11668
11669 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11670 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11671
11672 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11673
11674 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11675 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11676
11677 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11678
11679 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11680 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11681 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11682 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11683 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11684 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11685 more.
11686
11687 *** Support for the varioref package
11688
11689 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11690
11691 *** New hooks
11692
11693 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11694 and citations are created. These hooks are
11695 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11696 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11697
11698 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11699
11700 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11701 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11702
11703 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11704
11705 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11706 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11707 fontified, use
11708
11709 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11710
11711 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11712 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11713 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11714 directories that contain the same file name.
11715
11716 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11717 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11718 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11719 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11720 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11721 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11722 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11723 directory.
11724
11725 ** New modes and packages
11726
11727 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11728 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11729 it, but some do not.
11730
11731 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11732 code.
11733
11734 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11735 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11736 around in a buffer.
11737
11738 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11739
11740 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11741 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11742 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11743 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11744
11745 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11746 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11747 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11748
11749 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11750 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11751 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc.); others are implementations of
11752 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11753 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11754 the like.
11755
11756 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11757 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11758
11759 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11760 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11761 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11762 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11763
11764 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11765
11766 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11767 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11768 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11769 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11770 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc.)
11771 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11772 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11773 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11774 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11775 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11776 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11777
11778 Platform-specific modes:
11779
11780 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11781 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11782 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11783 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11784 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11785 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11786 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11787 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11788 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11789 \f
11790 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11791
11792 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11793 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11794 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11795 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11796
11797 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11798 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11799 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11800
11801 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11802 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11803 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11804 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11805
11806 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11807 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11808 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11809 environment.
11810
11811 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11812 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11813 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11814 current input method for reading this one event.
11815
11816 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11817 now control whether to output certain characters as
11818 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11819 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11820 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11821 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11822 \f
11823 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11824
11825 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11826 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11827
11828 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11829 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11830 always increases point by 1.
11831
11832 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11833 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11834
11835 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11836
11837 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11838 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11839 default value changed. For example,
11840
11841 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11842 :type 'integer
11843 :group 'foo
11844 :version "20.3")
11845
11846 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11847 :version "20.3")
11848
11849 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11850 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11851 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11852 `:version' in the top level group.
11853
11854 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11855
11856 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11857 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11858
11859 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11860 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11861 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11862 to themselves.
11863
11864 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11865 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11866 values whatever.
11867
11868 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11869 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11870 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11871
11872 ** Frame-local variables.
11873
11874 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11875 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11876 local bindings for that variable.
11877
11878 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11879 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11880 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11881 parameter name.
11882
11883 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11884 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11885 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11886 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11887
11888 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11889 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11890 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11891 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11892
11893 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11894 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11895 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11896 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11897 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11898
11899 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11900 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11901 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11902 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11903
11904 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11905 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11906
11907 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11908 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11909 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11910
11911 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11912 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11913 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11914 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11915
11916 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11917 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11918 empty input.
11919
11920 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11921 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11922 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11923 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11924 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11925
11926 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11927 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11928 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11929 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11930
11931 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11932 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11933 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11934 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11935 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11936
11937 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11938 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11939 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11940 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11941
11942 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11943 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11944 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11945
11946 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11947 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11948 was directed to display this buffer.
11949
11950 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11951 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11952 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11953 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11954 set-window-configuration.
11955
11956 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11957 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11958 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11959 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11960
11961 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11962 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11963 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11964
11965 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11966 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11967 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11968
11969 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11970 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11971
11972 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11973 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11974
11975 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11976 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11977 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11978
11979 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11980 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11981 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11982 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11983
11984 ** Menu changes
11985
11986 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11987 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11988 better supported.
11989
11990 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11991 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11992 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11993 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11994 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11995
11996 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11997
11998 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11999 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
12000 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
12001 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
12002
12003 The format is:
12004 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
12005 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
12006 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
12007 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
12008 The supported properties include
12009
12010 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
12011 item is enabled.
12012 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
12013 item should appear in the menu.
12014 :filter FILTER-FN
12015 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
12016 which will be REAL-BINDING.
12017 It should return a binding to use instead.
12018 :keys DESCRIPTION
12019 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
12020 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
12021 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
12022 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
12023 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
12024 keyboard binding.
12025 :key-sequence nil
12026 This means that the command normally has no
12027 keyboard equivalent.
12028 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
12029 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
12030 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
12031 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
12032 value says whether this button is currently selected.
12033
12034 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
12035 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
12036
12037 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
12038
12039 ** New event types
12040
12041 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
12042 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
12043 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
12044 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
12045
12046 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
12047
12048 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12049 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
12050 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
12051 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
12052 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
12053 forward, away from the user.
12054
12055 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12056
12057 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
12058 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
12059 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
12060 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
12061 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
12062
12063 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
12064
12065 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12066 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
12067 that were dragged and dropped.
12068
12069 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12070
12071 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
12072
12073 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
12074 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
12075 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
12076
12077 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
12078 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
12079 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
12080
12081 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
12082 in Emacs 19 and before.
12083
12084 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
12085 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
12086
12087 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
12088 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
12089 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
12090 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
12091
12092 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
12093 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
12094 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
12095 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
12096 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
12097
12098 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
12099 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
12100 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
12101 consistent with the new representation.
12102
12103 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
12104 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
12105 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
12106 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12107
12108 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
12109 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
12110 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
12111
12112 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
12113 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
12114 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12115
12116 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
12117 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
12118 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
12119
12120 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12121 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
12122
12123 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12124 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
12125
12126 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
12127 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
12128 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
12129 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
12130
12131 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
12132 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
12133
12134 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
12135 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
12136 buffer or string being searched.
12137
12138 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
12139 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
12140 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
12141 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
12142 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
12143 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
12144 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
12145
12146 *** Structure of coding system changed.
12147
12148 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
12149 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
12150 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12151 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12152 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12153 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12154 define-coding-system-alias.
12155
12156 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12157 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12158 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12159 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12160 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12161 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12162 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12163 `iso-8859-1'.
12164
12165 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12166 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12167 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12168 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12169
12170 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12171 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12172 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12173 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12174
12175 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12176 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12177 This function requires a user interaction.
12178
12179 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12180 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12181 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12182 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12183 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12184 select-safe-coding-system.
12185
12186 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12187 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12188 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12189 was done.
12190
12191 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12192 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12193 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12194
12195 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12196 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12197 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12198 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12199
12200 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12201 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12202 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12203 converted.
12204
12205 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12206 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12207
12208 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12209 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12210 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12211 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12212 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12213 range of characters.
12214
12215 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12216 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12217
12218 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12219 in the current buffer at position POS.
12220
12221 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12222 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12223 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12224 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12225 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12226 binding input-method-function to nil.
12227
12228 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12229 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12230 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12231 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12232 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12233
12234 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12235 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12236
12237 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12238 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12239
12240 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12241 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12242 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12243 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12244 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12245 \f
12246 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12247
12248 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12249 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12250 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12251 tree structure.
12252
12253 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12254 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12255
12256 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12257 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12258 in your .emacs file.)
12259
12260 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12261 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12262
12263 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12264 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12265
12266 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12267 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12268 kills the region.
12269
12270 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12271 delete the character before point, as usual.
12272
12273 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12274 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12275 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12276
12277 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12278 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12279 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12280 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12281 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12282 past.)
12283
12284 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12285 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12286 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12287 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12288 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12289
12290 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12291 and is an alias for it.
12292
12293 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12294 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12295
12296 ** Scrolling changes
12297
12298 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12299 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12300
12301 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12302 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12303 where it started.
12304
12305 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12306 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12307 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12308 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12309
12310 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12311 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12312 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12313 recenters the window.
12314
12315 ** International character set support (MULE)
12316
12317 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12318 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12319 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12320 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12321 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12322 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12323
12324 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12325 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12326 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12327 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12328 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12329
12330 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12331 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12332 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12333 language, to make it possible to type them.
12334
12335 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12336 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12337
12338 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12339 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12340
12341 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12342
12343 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12344
12345 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12346 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12347 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12348 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12349 characters for their work until they want to change.
12350
12351 *** Input methods
12352
12353 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12354 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12355 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12356 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12357 support several input methods.
12358
12359 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12360 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12361 work.
12362
12363 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12364 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12365 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12366 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12367 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12368 letter.
12369
12370 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12371 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12372 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12373 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12374 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12375
12376 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12377 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12378 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12379 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12380
12381 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12382 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12383 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12384 the first guess is wrong.
12385
12386 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12387 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12388
12389 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12390 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12391 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12392 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12393
12394 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12395 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12396 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12397 translate automatically to and from either one.
12398
12399 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12400
12401 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12402 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12403 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12404 what you want.
12405
12406 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12407 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12408 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12409 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12410
12411 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12412 character conversion as well.
12413
12414 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12415
12416 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12417 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12418 requires using many fonts.
12419
12420 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12421 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12422
12423 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12424 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12425 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12426 you would use a font.
12427
12428 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12429 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12430 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12431
12432 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12433 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12434 characters).
12435
12436 *** Defining fontsets.
12437
12438 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12439 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12440 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12441
12442 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12443 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12444 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12445 standard fontset are created automatically.
12446
12447 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12448 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12449 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12450 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12451 name is `fontset-startup'.
12452
12453 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12454 The resource value should have this form:
12455 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12456 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12457 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12458 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12459 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12460 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12461 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12462 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12463 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12464
12465 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12466 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12467 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12468
12469 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12470 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12471 following resource,
12472 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12473 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12474 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12475 Here is the substitution rule:
12476 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12477 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12478 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12479 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12480 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12481
12482 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12483 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12484 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12485
12486 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12487 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12488 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12489 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12490 fontsets.
12491
12492 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12493 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12494
12495 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12496 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12497 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12498 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12499 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12500 system for new files that you create.
12501
12502 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12503 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12504 whole Emacs session.
12505
12506 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12507 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12508 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12509
12510 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12511 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12512 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12513 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12514 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12515
12516 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12517 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12518 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12519 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12520 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12521
12522 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12523 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12524
12525 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12526 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12527
12528 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12529 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12530
12531 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12532 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12533 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12534 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12535 of the file.
12536
12537 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12538 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12539 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12540 translated into that character code.
12541
12542 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12543 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12544
12545 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12546
12547 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12548 the coding system for keyboard input.
12549
12550 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12551 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12552 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12553
12554 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12555
12556 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12557 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12558 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12559 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12560 designed to work with terminals.
12561
12562 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12563 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12564 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12565 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12566 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12567 in the corresponding buffer.
12568
12569 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12570
12571 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12572 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12573 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12574
12575 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12576 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12577 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12578 want to use.
12579
12580 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12581 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12582
12583 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12584 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12585 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12586 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12587
12588 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12589 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12590 related information.
12591
12592 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12593 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12594 scripts.
12595
12596 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12597 information about the support for a particular language.
12598 You specify the language as an argument.
12599
12600 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12601 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12602 first dash.
12603
12604 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12605 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12606 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12607 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12608
12609 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12610 B big5 (Chinese)
12611 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12612 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12613 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12614 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12615 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12616 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12617 K euc-korea (Korean)
12618 R koi8 (Russian)
12619 Q tibetan
12620 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12621 T lao
12622 T tis620 (Thai)
12623 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12624 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12625 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12626 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12627 z hz (Chinese)
12628
12629 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12630 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12631 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12632 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12633
12634 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12635 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12636
12637 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12638 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12639 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12640 Rmail files themselves.
12641
12642 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12643 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12644
12645 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12646 for sending mail:
12647
12648 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12649 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12650 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12651 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12652 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12653
12654 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12655 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12656 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12657 translations.
12658
12659 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12660 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12661 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12662 without any conversion.
12663
12664 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12665 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12666 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12667 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12668
12669 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12670 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12671
12672 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12673 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12674
12675 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12676 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12677
12678 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12679 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12680 in the buffer before point.
12681
12682 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12683 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12684 you are using.
12685
12686 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12687 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12688
12689 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12690
12691 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12692 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12693
12694 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12695 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12696 can become a bottleneck.
12697
12698 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12699 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12700 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12701 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12702 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12703 so useful that the change is worth while.
12704
12705 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12706 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12707 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12708 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12709
12710 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12711 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12712 show-paren-mode.
12713
12714 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12715 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12716 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12717
12718 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12719 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12720 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12721
12722 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12723 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12724 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12725
12726 ** Changes in View mode.
12727
12728 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12729 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12730
12731 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12732 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12733
12734 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12735 previous state.
12736
12737 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12738 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12739
12740 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12741 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12742 not just the selected window.
12743
12744 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12745 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12746 turns View mode on or off.
12747
12748 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12749 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12750 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12751
12752 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12753 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12754
12755 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12756 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12757 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12758 which version to compare with.
12759
12760 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12761 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12762
12763 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12764 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12765 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12766 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12767
12768 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12769 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12770 blocks, all of them or none.
12771
12772 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12773 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12774 confirmation first.
12775
12776 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12777 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12778 However, the mode will not be changed if
12779 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12780 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12781 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12782 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12783
12784 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12785
12786 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12787 these commands do not change the major mode.
12788
12789 ** M-x occur changes.
12790
12791 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12792 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12793
12794 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12795 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12796 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12797
12798 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12799 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12800 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12801 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12802 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12803
12804 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12805 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12806 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12807 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12808
12809 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12810 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12811 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12812
12813 ** Outline mode changes.
12814
12815 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12816
12817 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12818
12819 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12820 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12821 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12822 was already active.
12823
12824 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12825 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12826 get confused by it.
12827
12828 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12829 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12830
12831 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12832
12833 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12834 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12835 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12836 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12837
12838 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12839 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12840 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12841
12842 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12843 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12844 values.
12845
12846 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12847 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12848 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12849 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12850
12851 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12852 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12853 can be. The default value is 30.
12854
12855 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12856
12857 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12858 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12859 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12860 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12861 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12862 behavior.
12863
12864 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12865 compose-mail-other-frame.
12866
12867 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12868 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12869 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12870 buffer that shows the original message.
12871
12872 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12873 with separator lines around the contents.
12874
12875 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12876 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12877 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12878 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12879
12880 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12881
12882 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12883 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12884 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12885 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12886
12887 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12888 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12889 /etc/passwd.
12890
12891 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12892 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12893 /etc/passwd.
12894
12895 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12896 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12897 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12898 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12899
12900 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12901 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12902 be taken to be magic.
12903
12904 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12905 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12906 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12907
12908 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12909 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12910
12911 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12912 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12913
12914 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12915
12916 new key dired.el binding old key
12917 ------- ---------------- -------
12918 * c dired-change-marks c
12919 * m dired-mark m
12920 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12921 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12922 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12923 * u dired-unmark u
12924 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12925 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12926 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12927 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12928 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12929 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12930
12931 ** Rmail changes.
12932
12933 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12934 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12935 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12936 each time you run it.
12937
12938 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12939 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12940
12941 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12942 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12943 means to move in the opposite direction.
12944
12945 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12946 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12947
12948 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12949 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12950 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12951 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12952 for output.
12953
12954 ** Gnus changes.
12955
12956 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12957
12958 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12959 Gnus.
12960
12961 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12962 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12963
12964 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12965 article mode line.
12966
12967 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12968
12969 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12970
12971 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12972
12973 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12974 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12975 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12976
12977 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12978
12979 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12980
12981 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12982 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12983
12984 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12985 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12986 used to pick articles.
12987
12988 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12989 another have been added.
12990
12991 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12992
12993 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12994 generating lines in buffers.
12995
12996 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12997 `C-M-_'.
12998
12999 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
13000
13001 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
13002
13003 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
13004
13005 *** Scores can be decayed.
13006
13007 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
13008
13009 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
13010 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
13011
13012 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
13013 the native server.
13014
13015 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
13016
13017 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
13018 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
13019
13020 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
13021
13022 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
13023 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
13024
13025 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
13026 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
13027
13028 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
13029 a group.
13030
13031 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
13032 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
13033
13034 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
13035
13036 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
13037
13038 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
13039
13040 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
13041
13042 Use the `Y c' command.
13043
13044 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
13045
13046 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
13047
13048 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
13049
13050 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
13051 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
13052
13053 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
13054
13055 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
13056
13057 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
13058 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
13059
13060 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
13061
13062 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
13063 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
13064 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
13065 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
13066 this issue.)
13067
13068 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
13069 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
13070 particular news group. This can be done by:
13071
13072 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
13073
13074 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
13075 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
13076 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
13077 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
13078 for reading and posting).
13079
13080 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
13081 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
13082 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
13083 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
13084 there.
13085
13086 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
13087 default. Here are some of these default settings:
13088
13089 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
13090 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
13091 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
13092 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
13093 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
13094
13095 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
13096 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
13097
13098 ** CC mode changes.
13099
13100 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
13101 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
13102 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
13103 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
13104 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
13105 loaded.
13106
13107 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
13108 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
13109 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
13110 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
13111 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
13112 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
13113
13114 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
13115 of the current buffer.
13116
13117 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
13118 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
13119 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
13120
13121 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
13122 style that the Python developers like.
13123
13124 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
13125 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
13126 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
13127
13128 ** VC Changes [new]
13129
13130 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
13131 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
13132 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
13133
13134 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
13135 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
13136 developers.
13137
13138 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
13139 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
13140
13141 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
13142 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
13143 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
13144 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
13145
13146 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
13147 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
13148
13149 ** Calendar changes.
13150
13151 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13152 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13153 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13154 following/previous years.
13155
13156 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13157 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13158 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13159 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13160 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13161 supposed attribute of God.
13162
13163 ** ps-print changes
13164
13165 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13166 layout.
13167
13168 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13169
13170 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13171 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13172 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13173 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13174
13175 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13176 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13177 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13178
13179 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13180 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13181
13182 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13183 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13184 printing for your printer.
13185
13186 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13187 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13188
13189 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13190 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13191
13192 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13193 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13194 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13195 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13196 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13197 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13198 The default value is nil.
13199
13200 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13201 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13202
13203 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13204 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13205 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13206 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13207 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13208 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13209 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13210
13211 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13212 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13213
13214 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13215 The default is 0 ("black").
13216
13217 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13218 The default is 0 ("black").
13219
13220 border-width Specify the border width.
13221 The default is 0.4.
13222
13223 Any other property is ignored.
13224
13225 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13226 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13227 documentation).
13228
13229 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13230 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13231 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13232 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13233 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13234 controlling headers.
13235
13236 *** Color management (subgroup)
13237
13238 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13239 color.
13240
13241 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13242
13243 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13244 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13245 background should be used. Valid values are:
13246
13247 t always use face background color.
13248 nil never use face background color.
13249 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13250
13251 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13252
13253 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13254 sheet of paper.
13255
13256 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13257 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13258
13259 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13260 each page.
13261
13262 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13263 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13264 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13265
13266 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13267 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13268 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13269
13270 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13271 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13272 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13273
13274 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13275 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13276 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13277
13278 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13279 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13280 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13281
13282 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13283
13284 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13285
13286 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13287 RGB color.
13288
13289 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13290 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13291 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13292
13293 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13294 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13295 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13296 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13297 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13298 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13299 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13300 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13301 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13302 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13303 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13304 10 + 10 +
13305 11 + 11 +
13306 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13307 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13308 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13309 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13310 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13311 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13312 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13313 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13314 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13315 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13316 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13317 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13318 22 + 22 +
13319 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13320
13321 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13322
13323
13324 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13325
13326 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13327 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13328 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13329 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13330 to "-P".
13331
13332 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13333 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13334 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13335
13336 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13337 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13338 do so.
13339
13340 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13341
13342 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13343 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13344 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13345 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13346 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13347 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13348 `setpagedevice'.
13349
13350 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13351 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13352 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13353
13354 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13355 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13356 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13357 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13358 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13359 its TO, are ignored.
13360
13361 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13362 pages. Valid values are:
13363
13364 nil print all pages.
13365
13366 `even-page' print only even pages.
13367
13368 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13369
13370 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13371 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13372 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13373 print only the even sheet of paper.
13374
13375 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13376 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13377 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13378 only the odd sheet of paper.
13379
13380 Any other value is treated as nil.
13381
13382 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13383 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13384 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13385
13386 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13387
13388 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13389 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13390
13391 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13392 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13393 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13394 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13395 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13396 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13397 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13398
13399 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13400 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13401 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13402 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13403 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13404 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13405 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13406
13407 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13408
13409 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13410 messages should be sent.
13411
13412 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13413 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13414 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13415
13416 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13417
13418 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13419 points for line numbers.
13420
13421 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13422 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13423
13424 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13425 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13426 to 2, the printing will look like:
13427
13428 1 one line
13429 one line
13430 3 one line
13431 one line
13432 5 one line
13433 one line
13434 ...
13435
13436 Valid values are:
13437
13438 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13439 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13440 is used.
13441
13442 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13443 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13444
13445 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13446
13447 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13448 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13449 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13450 3, the output will look like:
13451
13452 one line
13453 one line
13454 3 one line
13455 one line
13456 one line
13457 6 one line
13458 one line
13459 one line
13460 9 one line
13461 one line
13462 ...
13463
13464 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13465 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13466
13467 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13468 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13469 `ps-font-size').
13470
13471 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13472 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13473 `ps-font-size').
13474
13475 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13476
13477 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13478 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13479
13480 ** hideshow changes.
13481
13482 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13483 C++, ; for lisp).
13484
13485 *** Support for java-mode added.
13486
13487 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13488 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13489
13490 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13491 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13492 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13493
13494 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13495 robust and a lot faster.
13496
13497 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13498
13499 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13500 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13501 documentation for more details.
13502
13503 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13504
13505 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13506 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13507 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13508 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13509 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13510
13511 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13512 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13513 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13514 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13515
13516 ** Font Lock mode
13517
13518 *** Custom support
13519
13520 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13521 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13522 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13523 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13524 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13525 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13526
13527 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13528
13529 *** Maximum decoration
13530
13531 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13532 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13533 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13534 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13535 to get the old behavior.
13536
13537 *** New support
13538
13539 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13540
13541 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13542 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13543
13544 *** Configurable support
13545
13546 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13547 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13548 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13549 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13550 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13551 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13552 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13553
13554 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13555 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13556 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13557
13558 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13559
13560 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13561 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13562 for any mode.
13563
13564 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13565
13566 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13567
13568 in your ~/.emacs.
13569
13570 *** New faces
13571
13572 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13573 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13574 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13575 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13576
13577 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13578
13579 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13580 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13581 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13582
13583 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13584
13585 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13586 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13587 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13588 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13589 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13590 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13591 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13592
13593 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13594 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13595 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13596 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13597 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13598 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13599
13600 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13601
13602 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13603 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13604 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13605 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13606
13607 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13608 settings.
13609
13610 ** Ada mode changes.
13611
13612 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13613 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13614 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13615 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13616 stubs.
13617
13618 *** There are two new commands:
13619 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13620 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13621
13622 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13623 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13624 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13625
13626 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13627 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13628 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13629
13630 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13631 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13632 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13633 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13634
13635 ** Scheme mode changes.
13636
13637 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13638 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13639 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13640 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13641 have any effect.
13642
13643 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13644 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13645 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13646 variables as buffer-local variables.
13647
13648 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13649 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13650
13651 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13652
13653 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13654 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13655 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13656 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13657
13658 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13659 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13660 buffer in Emacs.
13661
13662 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13663 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13664 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13665 option takes precedence.
13666
13667 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13668 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13669 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13670
13671 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13672 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13673 the current defun.
13674
13675 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13676 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13677
13678 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13679 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13680 necessary).
13681
13682 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13683 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13684 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13685 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13686 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13687 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13688
13689 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13690 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13691 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13692 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13693
13694 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13695 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13696 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13697 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13698 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13699
13700 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13701 since it applies only to the current frame.
13702
13703 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13704 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13705 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13706
13707 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13708 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13709 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13710 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13711 instead of just the file you are editing.
13712
13713 ** RefTeX mode
13714
13715 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13716 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13717 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13718 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13719 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13720
13721 C-c ( reftex-label
13722 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13723 knows which kind of label is needed.
13724
13725 C-c ) reftex-reference
13726 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13727 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13728
13729 C-c [ reftex-citation
13730 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13731 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13732
13733 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13734 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13735
13736 C-c = reftex-toc
13737 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13738 can quickly jump to every section.
13739
13740 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13741 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13742 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13743 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13744 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13745
13746 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13747
13748 *** Info documentation is now available.
13749
13750 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13751 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13752
13753 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13754 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13755
13756 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13757 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13758
13759 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13760 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13761 appropriate functions.
13762
13763 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13764 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13765
13766 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13767 been cleaned.
13768
13769 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13770 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13771
13772 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13773 shall be delimited.
13774
13775 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13776 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13777 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13778
13779 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13780 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13781 prefixed with `ALT'.
13782
13783 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13784 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13785 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13786 documentation).
13787
13788 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13789 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13790 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13791
13792 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13793 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13794
13795 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13796 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13797 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13798
13799 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13800
13801 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13802
13803 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13804 from alien sources.
13805
13806 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13807 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13808 crossref entries.
13809
13810 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13811 region.
13812
13813 *** Added support for imenu.
13814
13815 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13816 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13817 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13818 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13819
13820 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13821 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13822
13823 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13824
13825 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13826
13827 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13828 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13829 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13830 as an argument.
13831
13832 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13833 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13834
13835 ** browse-url changes
13836
13837 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13838 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13839 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13840 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13841 customization variables.
13842
13843 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13844
13845 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13846 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13847 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13848
13849 ** Changes in Ediff
13850
13851 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13852 pops up the Info file for this command.
13853
13854 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13855 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13856 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13857 directories).
13858
13859 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13860 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13861 files in the same directory.
13862
13863 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13864 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13865 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13866
13867 ** Changes in Viper
13868
13869 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13870 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13871 instead of vip-.
13872 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13873 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13874 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13875 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13876 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13877 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13878 color when Viper is in insert state.
13879 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13880 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13881 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13882
13883 ** Etags changes.
13884
13885 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13886 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13887 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13888 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13889 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13890
13891 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13892
13893 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13894 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13895
13896 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13897 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13898 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13899
13900 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13901 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13902 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13903 methods and protocols.
13904
13905 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13906 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13907 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13908 paragraph name.
13909
13910 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13911 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13912 at least M times and as many as N times.
13913
13914 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13915 in files has changed slightly.
13916
13917 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13918 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13919 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13920 with old time-stamp-format values.
13921
13922 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13923 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13924 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13925 reasons.
13926
13927 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13928 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13929 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13930 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13931 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13932 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13933
13934 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13935 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13936 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13937
13938 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13939 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13940 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13941 recommended now will continue to work then.
13942
13943 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13944 details.
13945
13946 ** There are some additional major modes:
13947
13948 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13949 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13950 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13951
13952 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13953 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13954 into Emacs.
13955
13956 ** New Lisp packages include:
13957
13958 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13959
13960 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13961 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13962
13963 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13964
13965 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13966 in shell buffers.
13967
13968 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13969 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13970 and `elint-defun'.
13971
13972 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13973 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13974 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13975 strings or comments.
13976
13977 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13978 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13979 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13980 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13981 at these points.
13982
13983 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13984 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13985
13986 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13987 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13988
13989 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13990
13991 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13992 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13993
13994 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13995
13996 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13997
13998 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13999
14000 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
14001 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
14002
14003 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
14004 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
14005 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
14006 original place after inserting the copy.
14007
14008 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
14009 on the buffer.
14010
14011 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
14012 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
14013 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
14014
14015 Enable mouse-drag with:
14016 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
14017 -or-
14018 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
14019
14020 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
14021 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
14022
14023 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
14024 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
14025
14026 *** ogonek
14027
14028 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
14029 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
14030 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
14031 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
14032 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
14033 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
14034 instance) and vice versa.
14035
14036 To use this package load it using
14037 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
14038 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
14039 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
14040 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
14041 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
14042 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
14043
14044 *** Interface to ph.
14045
14046 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
14047
14048 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
14049 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
14050 these servers.
14051
14052 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
14053
14054 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
14055 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
14056 while the real cursor does not move.
14057
14058 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
14059 for visiting your favorite web sites.
14060
14061 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
14062 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
14063
14064 ** movemail change
14065
14066 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
14067 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
14068 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
14069 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
14070
14071 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
14072 \f
14073 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
14074
14075 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
14076
14077 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
14078 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
14079 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
14080 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
14081 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
14082
14083 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
14084 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
14085 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
14086 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
14087 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
14088 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
14089 \f
14090 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
14091
14092 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
14093 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
14094 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
14095 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
14096
14097 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
14098 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
14099
14100 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
14101 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
14102 "win".
14103
14104 ** Basic Lisp changes
14105
14106 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
14107 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
14108
14109 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
14110 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
14111 or by the user.
14112
14113 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
14114
14115 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
14116
14117 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
14118 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
14119
14120 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
14121 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
14122 its argument.
14123
14124 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
14125
14126 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
14127
14128 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
14129
14130 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
14131 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
14132 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
14133 `format' function.
14134
14135 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
14136 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
14137 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
14138
14139 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
14140 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
14141 adding one of these suffixes.
14142
14143 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
14144 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
14145 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
14146
14147 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
14148 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
14149
14150 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14151
14152 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14153 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14154
14155 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14156 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14157
14158 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14159
14160 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14161 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14162
14163 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14164 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14165 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14166 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14167
14168 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14169 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14170 of the last form.
14171
14172 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14173 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14174 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14175 as the last form.
14176
14177 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14178 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14179 matches.
14180
14181 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14182
14183 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14184 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14185 Then it returns that string.
14186
14187 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14188
14189 (with-output-to-string
14190 (princ "The buffer is ")
14191 (princ (buffer-name)))
14192
14193 returns "The buffer is foo".
14194
14195 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14196 is non-nil.
14197
14198 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14199 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14200 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14201
14202 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14203 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14204
14205 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14206 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14207 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14208 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14209 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14210 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14211
14212 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14213 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14214 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14215 characters".
14216
14217 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14218 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14219 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14220 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14221 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14222
14223 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14224 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14225 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14226 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14227
14228 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14229 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14230
14231 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14232
14233 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14234 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14235 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14236 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14237 guaranteed.
14238
14239 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14240 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14241 character).
14242
14243 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14244
14245 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14246 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14247 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14248 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14249 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14250
14251 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14252
14253 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14254 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14255 more than the number of characters.
14256
14257 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14258 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14259 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14260 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14261 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14262 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14263
14264 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14265 and returns a string containing those characters.
14266
14267 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14268 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14269 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14270 character, sref signals an error.
14271
14272 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14273 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14274 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14275
14276 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14277 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14278 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14279
14280 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14281 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14282 to a vector of the characters in it.
14283
14284 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14285 of a string. You call it as follows:
14286
14287 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14288
14289 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14290 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14291 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14292 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14293 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14294
14295 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14296 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14297
14298 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14299 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14300
14301 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14302 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14303 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14304 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14305
14306 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14307
14308 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14309
14310 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14311 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14312 are not included in the resulting value.
14313
14314 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14315 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14316 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14317 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14318
14319 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14320 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14321 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14322 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14323 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14324 column START-COLUMN.
14325
14326 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14327 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14328 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14329 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14330 changed text, before the change.
14331
14332 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14333 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14334 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14335
14336 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14337
14338 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14339
14340 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14341 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14342
14343 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14344 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14345 which identify the character within that character set.
14346
14347 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14348 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14349 opposite of split-char.
14350
14351 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14352 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14353
14354 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14355 of all the characters in a string.
14356
14357 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14358 and specifying coding systems.
14359
14360 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14361 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14362 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14363 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14364 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14365 as what to do about code conversion.)
14366
14367 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14368 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14369
14370 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14371 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14372 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14373
14374 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14375 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14376 to match against a file name.
14377
14378 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14379 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14380 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14381 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14382 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14383 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14384
14385 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14386 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14387
14388 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14389 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14390
14391 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14392 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14393 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14394 service names.
14395
14396 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14397 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14398 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14399 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14400 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14401 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14402
14403 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14404 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14405
14406 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14407 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14408 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14409 start the subprocess.
14410
14411 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14412 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14413 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14414 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14415 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14416
14417 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14418 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14419 subprocess.
14420
14421 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14422 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14423 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14424 connection permanently or until overridden.
14425
14426 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14427 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14428 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14429 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14430 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14431 system for one operation at a time.
14432
14433 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14434 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14435
14436 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14437 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14438 The value is a cons cell,
14439 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14440 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14441 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14442 input to the subprocess.
14443
14444 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14445 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14446
14447 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14448 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14449 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14450
14451 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14452 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14453 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14454 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14455 customization.
14456
14457 Thus, instead of writing
14458
14459 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14460 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14461
14462 you would now write this:
14463
14464 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14465 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14466 :type 'boolean
14467 :group foo)
14468
14469 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14470 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14471 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14472 for a description of them.
14473
14474 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14475 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14476
14477 (defgroup ispell nil
14478 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14479 :group 'processes)
14480
14481 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14482 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14483 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14484 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14485 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14486
14487 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14488 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14489 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14490 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14491 first-level subgroups.
14492
14493 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14494
14495 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14496 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14497
14498 ** easy-mmode
14499
14500 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14501 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14502 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14503 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14504 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14505 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14506
14507 ** Text property changes
14508
14509 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14510 text property.
14511
14512 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14513 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14514 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14515 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14516 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14517
14518 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14519 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14520 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14521 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14522
14523 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14524 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14525 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14526
14527 ** Changes in invisibility features
14528
14529 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14530 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14531 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14532 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14533 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14534 make the overlay visible.
14535
14536 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14537 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14538 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14539 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14540 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14541 t when it should hide it.
14542
14543 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14544
14545 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14546 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14547 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14548 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14549 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14550 Here is an example of how to do this:
14551
14552 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14553 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14554 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14555 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14556
14557 ...
14558 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14559
14560 ...
14561 ;; When done with the overlays:
14562 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14563 ;; Or respectively:
14564 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14565
14566 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14567
14568 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14569 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14570 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14571 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14572
14573 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14574 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14575 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14576
14577 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14578 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14579
14580 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14581 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14582
14583 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14584 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14585 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14586
14587 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14588 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14589 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14590 determine the syntax type of the character.
14591
14592 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14593 of the current buffer.
14594
14595 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14596 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14597 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14598
14599 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14600 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14601 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14602 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14603 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14604
14605 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14606 text property.
14607
14608 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14609 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14610 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14611
14612 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14613 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14614 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14615 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14616 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14617
14618 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14619 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14620 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14621
14622 ** Changes in face features
14623
14624 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14625 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14626
14627 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14628 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14629
14630 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14631 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14632
14633 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14634 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14635
14636 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14637 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14638 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14639 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14640 overlay property).
14641
14642 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14643 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14644
14645 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14646
14647 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14648 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14649 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14650 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14651
14652 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14653 begins with ~.
14654
14655 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14656 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14657
14658 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14659 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14660
14661 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14662 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14663
14664 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14665 character code conversion as well as other things.
14666
14667 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14668 (formerly it did not).
14669
14670 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14671 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14672
14673 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14674 instead of constant strings.
14675
14676 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14677 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14678 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14679
14680 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14681 in the same way as before.
14682
14683 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14684 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14685 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14686
14687 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14688 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14689 else, and returns nil.
14690
14691 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14692 directory cannot be listed.
14693
14694 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14695
14696 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14697 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14698 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14699 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14700 ways:
14701
14702 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14703 It is available through the history command M-n.
14704
14705 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14706 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14707 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14708 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14709 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14710
14711 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14712 argument in this way.
14713
14714 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14715 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14716 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14717
14718 ** Echo area features
14719
14720 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14721 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14722 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14723 after the echo area is cleared.
14724
14725 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14726 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14727
14728 ** Keyboard input features
14729
14730 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14731 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14732
14733 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14734 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14735 by keyboard macros.
14736
14737 ** Frame-related changes
14738
14739 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14740 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14741 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14742
14743 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14744 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14745 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14746
14747 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14748 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14749 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14750 in the selected frame.
14751
14752 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14753 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14754 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14755
14756 ** X Windows features
14757
14758 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14759 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14760 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14761
14762 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14763 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14764
14765 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14766 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14767 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14768
14769 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14770 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14771
14772 ** Subprocess features
14773
14774 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14775 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14776 automatically.
14777
14778 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14779 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14780
14781 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14782 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14783
14784 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14785 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14786
14787 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14788 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14789 goes after the other menu items.
14790
14791 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14792 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14793 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14794 are in use.
14795
14796 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14797 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14798
14799 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14800 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14801 form.
14802
14803 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14804 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14805 but its hook is still run.
14806
14807 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14808 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14809
14810 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14811 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14812 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14813
14814 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14815 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14816 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14817 warned.
14818
14819 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14820 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14821
14822 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14823 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14824 functions like display-time.
14825
14826 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14827 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14828
14829 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14830 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14831 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14832
14833 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14834 if there is an error in compilation.
14835
14836 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14837 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14838 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14839 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14840
14841 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14842 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14843 the *scratch* buffer.
14844
14845 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14846 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14847 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14848 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14849
14850 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14851 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14852 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14853
14854 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14855 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14856 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14857 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14858
14859 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14860 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14861 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14862
14863 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14864 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14865 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14866 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14867 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14868 files at all.
14869
14870 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14871 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14872 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14873 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14874
14875 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14876 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14877 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14878 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14879
14880 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14881
14882 ** imenu.el changes.
14883
14884 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14885 item from menu created by imenu.
14886
14887 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14888 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14889 select one of those items.
14890 \f
14891 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14892
14893 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14894 Copyright information:
14895
14896 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
14897 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14898
14899 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14900 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14901 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14902 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14903
14904 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14905 of this document, or of portions of it,
14906 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14907 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14908 \f
14909 Local variables:
14910 mode: outline
14911 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14912 end:
14913
14914 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793